1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 /* 3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface 4 * 5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc. 6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz> 7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2023 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #ifndef MAC80211_H 14 #define MAC80211_H 15 16 #include <linux/bug.h> 17 #include <linux/kernel.h> 18 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 19 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 21 #include <linux/lockdep.h> 22 #include <net/cfg80211.h> 23 #include <net/codel.h> 24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h> 25 #include <asm/unaligned.h> 26 27 /** 28 * DOC: Introduction 29 * 30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements 31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document 32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware 33 * drivers. 34 */ 35 36 /** 37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts 38 * 39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be 40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any 41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such 42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the 43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even 44 * tasklet function. 45 * 46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also 47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions! 48 */ 49 50 /** 51 * DOC: Warning 52 * 53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will 54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet. 55 */ 56 57 /** 58 * DOC: Frame format 59 * 60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver, 61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are 62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the 63 * hardware. 64 * 65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features: 66 * 67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload 68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware. 69 * 70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to 71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU. 72 */ 73 74 /** 75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue 76 * 77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use. 78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by 79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the 80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback. 81 * 82 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during 83 * suspend. 84 * 85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock. 86 * 87 */ 88 89 /** 90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing 91 * 92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the 93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between 94 * different stations/interfaces. 95 * 96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either 97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom 98 * handler. 99 * 100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with 101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and 102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames. 103 * 104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations 105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops. 106 * 107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly. 108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue 109 * driver op. 110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling 111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will 112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation. 113 * 114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to 115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to 116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls 117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using 118 * ieee80211_return_txq(). 119 * 120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has 121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling 122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq 123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls 124 * .release_buffered_frames(). 125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own 126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained 127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue). 128 */ 129 130 /** 131 * DOC: HW timestamping 132 * 133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps 134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks. 135 * 136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing 137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp 138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the 139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct. 140 * 141 * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine 142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field 143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the 144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct. 145 */ 146 struct device; 147 148 /** 149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues 150 * 151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues. 152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set 153 */ 154 enum ieee80211_max_queues { 155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16, 156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1, 157 }; 158 159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff 160 161 /** 162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211 163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice 164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video 165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort 166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background 167 */ 168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers { 169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0, 170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1, 171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2, 172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3, 173 }; 174 175 /** 176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration 177 * 178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS 179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29. 180 * 181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255] 182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form 183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min] 185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category 187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue 188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured 189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE 190 */ 191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params { 192 u16 txop; 193 u16 cw_min; 194 u16 cw_max; 195 u8 aifs; 196 bool acm; 197 bool uapsd; 198 bool mu_edca; 199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec; 200 }; 201 202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats { 203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount; 204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount; 205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount; 206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount; 207 }; 208 209 /** 210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context 211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed 212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed 213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed 214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel, 215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA 216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed 217 */ 218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change { 219 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0), 220 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1), 221 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2), 222 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3), 223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4), 224 }; 225 226 /** 227 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to 228 * 229 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx 230 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only. 231 * 232 * @def: the channel definition 233 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required. 234 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be 235 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions 236 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled 237 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions; 238 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static. 239 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel. 240 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 241 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information. 242 */ 243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf { 244 struct cfg80211_chan_def def; 245 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def; 246 247 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic; 248 249 bool radar_enabled; 250 251 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 252 }; 253 254 /** 255 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode 256 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already 257 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface 258 * needs to be switched from one to the other. 259 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop 260 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but 261 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches 262 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course 263 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing 264 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context 265 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used 266 * for changes/removal.) 267 */ 268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode { 269 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF, 270 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS, 271 }; 272 273 /** 274 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information 275 * 276 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that 277 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The 278 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be 279 * done. 280 * 281 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx 282 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching 283 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned 284 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned 285 */ 286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch { 287 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 288 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf; 289 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx; 290 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx; 291 }; 292 293 /** 294 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags 295 * 296 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed() 297 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed. 298 * 299 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated), 300 * also implies a change in the AID. 301 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed 302 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed 303 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed 304 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed 305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed 306 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed 307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever 308 * reason (IBSS and managed mode) 309 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve 310 * new beacon (beaconing modes) 311 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be 312 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes) 313 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed 314 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed 315 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed. 316 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note 317 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode. 318 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface. 319 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode) 320 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode) 321 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode) 322 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface 323 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS) 324 * changed 325 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available: 326 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration. 327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed, 328 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel 329 * context had been assigned. 330 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed 331 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed 332 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected 333 * keep alive) changed. 334 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface 335 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder 336 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode). 337 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed 338 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed. 339 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed 340 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed. 341 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 342 * status changed. 343 * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed. 344 */ 345 enum ieee80211_bss_change { 346 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0, 347 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1, 348 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2, 349 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3, 350 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4, 351 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5, 352 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6, 353 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7, 354 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8, 355 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9, 356 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10, 357 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11, 358 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12, 359 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13, 360 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14, 361 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15, 362 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16, 363 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17, 364 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18, 365 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19, 366 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20, 367 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21, 368 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22, 369 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23, 370 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24, 371 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25, 372 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26, 373 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27, 374 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28, 375 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29, 376 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30, 377 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31, 378 BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING = BIT_ULL(32), 379 380 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */ 381 }; 382 383 /* 384 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number 385 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP 386 * filtering will be disabled. 387 */ 388 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4 389 390 /** 391 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver 392 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver. 393 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME 394 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received 395 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because 396 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only 397 * once each time the timeout triggers. 398 */ 399 enum ieee80211_event_type { 400 RSSI_EVENT, 401 MLME_EVENT, 402 BAR_RX_EVENT, 403 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT, 404 }; 405 406 /** 407 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT 408 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver. 409 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver. 410 */ 411 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data { 412 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH, 413 RSSI_EVENT_LOW, 414 }; 415 416 /** 417 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT 418 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data 419 */ 420 struct ieee80211_rssi_event { 421 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data; 422 }; 423 424 /** 425 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT 426 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication 427 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association 428 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received.. 429 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent. 430 */ 431 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data { 432 AUTH_EVENT, 433 ASSOC_EVENT, 434 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT, 435 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT, 436 }; 437 438 /** 439 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT 440 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully. 441 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer. 442 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out. 443 */ 444 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status { 445 MLME_SUCCESS, 446 MLME_DENIED, 447 MLME_TIMEOUT, 448 }; 449 450 /** 451 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT 452 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data 453 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status 454 * @reason: the reason code if applicable 455 */ 456 struct ieee80211_mlme_event { 457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data; 458 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status; 459 u16 reason; 460 }; 461 462 /** 463 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events 464 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates 465 * @tid: the tid 466 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT) 467 */ 468 struct ieee80211_ba_event { 469 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 470 u16 tid; 471 u16 ssn; 472 }; 473 474 /** 475 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver 476 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type. 477 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT 478 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT 479 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT 480 * @u:union holding the fields above 481 */ 482 struct ieee80211_event { 483 enum ieee80211_event_type type; 484 union { 485 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi; 486 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme; 487 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba; 488 } u; 489 }; 490 491 /** 492 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data 493 * 494 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO 495 * 496 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group 497 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group 498 */ 499 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data { 500 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN]; 501 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN]; 502 }; 503 504 /** 505 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters 506 * 507 * @lci: LCI subelement content 508 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content 509 * @lci_len: LCI data length 510 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length 511 */ 512 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params { 513 const u8 *lci; 514 const u8 *civicloc; 515 size_t lci_len; 516 size_t civicloc_len; 517 }; 518 519 /** 520 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 521 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 522 * 523 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 524 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 525 */ 526 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery { 527 u32 min_interval; 528 u32 max_interval; 529 }; 530 531 /** 532 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters 533 * 534 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association 535 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS. 536 * 537 * @vif: reference to owning VIF 538 * @addr: (link) address used locally 539 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO 540 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE 541 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP 542 * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either 543 * ACK, BACK or both 544 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field 545 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us 546 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE 547 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed 548 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role) 549 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed 550 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role) 551 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames 552 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT 553 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection 554 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble 555 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP) 556 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing, 557 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified 558 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then. 559 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old 560 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the 561 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can 562 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after 563 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the 564 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice. 565 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf, 566 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation 567 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice. 568 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY 569 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts. 570 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync 571 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently 572 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks. 573 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't 574 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this. 575 * @beacon_int: beacon interval 576 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp 577 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an 578 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in 579 * the current band. 580 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate 581 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 582 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS 583 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not 584 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be 585 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example. 586 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data 587 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation. 588 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel. 589 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must 590 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT. 591 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value 592 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should 593 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in 594 * relation to the newly configured threshold. 595 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value 596 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single 597 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it. 598 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold. 599 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis 600 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS. 601 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode. 602 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured. 603 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit 604 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular 605 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is 606 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from 607 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to 608 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace) 609 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave 610 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed 611 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS 612 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support. 613 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from 614 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated. 615 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include 616 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element. 617 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN 618 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the 619 * station. 620 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM 621 * responder functionality. 622 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder. 623 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile 624 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP 625 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set 626 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set 627 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of 628 * nontransmitted BSSIDs 629 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received 630 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set. 631 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are 632 * connected to (STA) 633 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters. 634 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE 635 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration 636 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 637 * interval. 638 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed 639 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware. 640 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz 641 * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS. 642 * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env. 643 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS. 644 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT 645 * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS 646 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. 647 * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch 648 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability 649 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL 650 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX 651 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always 652 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be 653 * processed after it switches back to %NULL. 654 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. 655 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change. 656 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability. 657 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability. 658 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability. 659 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU 660 * beamformer 661 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU 662 * beamformee 663 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU 664 * beamformer 665 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU 666 * beamformee 667 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU 668 * beamformer 669 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU 670 * beamformee 671 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU 672 * beamformer 673 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission 674 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU 675 * bandwidth 676 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU 677 * beamformer 678 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU 679 * beamformee 680 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU 681 * beamformer 682 */ 683 struct ieee80211_bss_conf { 684 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 685 686 const u8 *bssid; 687 unsigned int link_id; 688 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 689 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext; 690 bool uora_exists; 691 u8 uora_ocw_range; 692 u16 frame_time_rts_th; 693 bool he_support; 694 bool twt_requester; 695 bool twt_responder; 696 bool twt_protected; 697 bool twt_broadcast; 698 /* erp related data */ 699 bool use_cts_prot; 700 bool use_short_preamble; 701 bool use_short_slot; 702 bool enable_beacon; 703 u8 dtim_period; 704 u16 beacon_int; 705 u16 assoc_capability; 706 u64 sync_tsf; 707 u32 sync_device_ts; 708 u8 sync_dtim_count; 709 u32 basic_rates; 710 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate; 711 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 712 u16 ht_operation_mode; 713 s32 cqm_rssi_thold; 714 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst; 715 s32 cqm_rssi_low; 716 s32 cqm_rssi_high; 717 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 718 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group; 719 bool qos; 720 bool hidden_ssid; 721 int txpower; 722 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type; 723 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr; 724 bool allow_p2p_go_ps; 725 u16 max_idle_period; 726 bool protected_keep_alive; 727 bool ftm_responder; 728 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params; 729 /* Multiple BSSID data */ 730 bool nontransmitted; 731 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 732 u8 bssid_index; 733 u8 bssid_indicator; 734 bool ema_ap; 735 u8 profile_periodicity; 736 struct { 737 u32 params; 738 u16 nss_set; 739 } he_oper; 740 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 741 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 742 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 743 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval; 744 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate; 745 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type; 746 struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT]; 747 u8 tx_pwr_env_num; 748 u8 pwr_reduction; 749 bool eht_support; 750 u16 eht_puncturing; 751 752 bool csa_active; 753 u16 csa_punct_bitmap; 754 755 bool mu_mimo_owner; 756 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf; 757 758 bool color_change_active; 759 u8 color_change_color; 760 761 bool ht_ldpc; 762 bool vht_ldpc; 763 bool he_ldpc; 764 bool vht_su_beamformer; 765 bool vht_su_beamformee; 766 bool vht_mu_beamformer; 767 bool vht_mu_beamformee; 768 bool he_su_beamformer; 769 bool he_su_beamformee; 770 bool he_mu_beamformer; 771 bool he_full_ul_mumimo; 772 bool eht_su_beamformer; 773 bool eht_su_beamformee; 774 bool eht_mu_beamformer; 775 }; 776 777 /** 778 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status 779 * 780 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info. 781 * 782 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame. 783 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence 784 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment 785 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the 786 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly 787 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly 788 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from 789 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing. 790 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to 791 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE 792 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for 793 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field. 794 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack 795 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination 796 * station 797 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame 798 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon 799 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU 800 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211. 801 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted 802 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to 803 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or 804 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station 805 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on 806 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for 807 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above), 808 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the 809 * hardware queue. 810 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged 811 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status 812 * is for the whole aggregation. 813 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned, 814 * so consider using block ack request (BAR). 815 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be 816 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will 817 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment) 818 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate 819 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for 820 * off-channel operation. 821 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation 822 * (header conversion) 823 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211, 824 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS 825 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211, 826 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted 827 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll 828 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must 829 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode. 830 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the 831 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used 832 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the 833 * queue gets full. 834 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted 835 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not 836 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.) 837 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME 838 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status 839 * should kick the MLME state machine. 840 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211 841 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX 842 * status to user space) 843 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame 844 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this 845 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use. 846 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on 847 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done 848 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be 849 * handled properly by the device. 850 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP 851 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow 852 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested. 853 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate. 854 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P 855 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band. 856 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period, 857 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in 858 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames 859 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for 860 * PS-Poll responses. 861 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate. 862 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when 863 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose. 864 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it 865 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for 866 * monitor injection). 867 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with 868 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without 869 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW). 870 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack 871 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK. 872 * 873 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't 874 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary. 875 */ 876 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags { 877 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0), 878 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1), 879 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2), 880 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3), 881 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4), 882 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5), 883 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6), 884 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7), 885 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8), 886 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9), 887 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10), 888 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11), 889 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12), 890 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13), 891 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14), 892 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15), 893 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16), 894 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17), 895 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18), 896 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19), 897 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20), 898 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21), 899 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22), 900 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24), 901 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25), 902 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26), 903 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27), 904 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28), 905 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29), 906 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30), 907 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31), 908 }; 909 910 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23 911 912 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS 913 914 /** 915 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control 916 * 917 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control 918 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP) 919 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll 920 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD). 921 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information 922 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame 923 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path 924 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup 925 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211, 926 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before 927 * it can be sent out. 928 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that 929 * has already been assigned to this frame. 930 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered 931 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent 932 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values. 933 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally 934 * for sequence number assignment 935 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this 936 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is 937 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is 938 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame 939 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if 940 * it's intended for an MLD. 941 * 942 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags. 943 */ 944 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags { 945 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0), 946 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1), 947 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2), 948 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3), 949 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4), 950 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5), 951 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6), 952 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7), 953 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8), 954 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9), 955 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000, 956 }; 957 958 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf 959 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \ 960 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \ 961 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK) 962 963 /** 964 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status 965 * 966 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid 967 * 968 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags. 969 */ 970 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags { 971 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0), 972 }; 973 974 /* 975 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are 976 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack. 977 */ 978 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \ 979 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \ 980 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \ 981 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \ 982 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \ 983 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \ 984 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \ 985 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) 986 987 /** 988 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the 989 * Rate Control algorithm. 990 * 991 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx, 992 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate. 993 * 994 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate. 995 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required. 996 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection. 997 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble. 998 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate. 999 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split 1000 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number) 1001 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in 1002 * Greenfield mode. 1003 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz. 1004 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission 1005 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission 1006 * (80+80 isn't supported yet) 1007 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the 1008 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is 1009 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS. 1010 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate. 1011 */ 1012 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags { 1013 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0), 1014 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1), 1015 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2), 1016 1017 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */ 1018 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3), 1019 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4), 1020 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5), 1021 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6), 1022 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7), 1023 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8), 1024 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9), 1025 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10), 1026 }; 1027 1028 1029 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */ 1030 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40 1031 1032 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */ 1033 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24 1034 1035 /* maximum number of rate stages */ 1036 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4 1037 1038 /* maximum number of rate table entries */ 1039 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4 1040 1041 /** 1042 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status 1043 * 1044 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with 1045 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags) 1046 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate 1047 * 1048 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used 1049 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried. 1050 * 1051 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should 1052 * always report the rate along with the flags it used. 1053 * 1054 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs 1055 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate 1056 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example, 1057 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the 1058 * information:: 1059 * 1060 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 } 1061 * 1062 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted 1063 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four 1064 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets 1065 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status 1066 * information should then contain:: 1067 * 1068 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ... 1069 * 1070 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2 1071 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement. 1072 */ 1073 struct ieee80211_tx_rate { 1074 s8 idx; 1075 u16 count:5, 1076 flags:11; 1077 } __packed; 1078 1079 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31 1080 1081 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate, 1082 u8 mcs, u8 nss) 1083 { 1084 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF); 1085 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7); 1086 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs; 1087 } 1088 1089 static inline u8 1090 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1091 { 1092 return rate->idx & 0xF; 1093 } 1094 1095 static inline u8 1096 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1097 { 1098 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1; 1099 } 1100 1101 /** 1102 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information 1103 * 1104 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses: 1105 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do 1106 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable) 1107 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened 1108 * 1109 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above 1110 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races), 1111 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which 1112 * link the frame will be transmitted on 1113 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC 1114 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately, 1115 * see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation 1116 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame 1117 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally 1118 * @control: union part for control data 1119 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try 1120 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS 1121 * @control.use_rts: use RTS 1122 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS 1123 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only) 1124 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table 1125 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients 1126 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL) 1127 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL) 1128 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags 1129 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs) 1130 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space 1131 * @pad: padding 1132 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates 1133 * @status: union part for status data 1134 * @status.rates: attempted rates 1135 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal 1136 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length 1137 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length 1138 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy) 1139 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only 1140 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness 1141 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags 1142 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area 1143 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data 1144 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK 1145 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers 1146 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames. 1147 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set. 1148 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames. 1149 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set. 1150 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame 1151 */ 1152 struct ieee80211_tx_info { 1153 /* common information */ 1154 u32 flags; 1155 u32 band:3, 1156 status_data_idr:1, 1157 status_data:13, 1158 hw_queue:4, 1159 tx_time_est:10; 1160 /* 1 free bit */ 1161 1162 union { 1163 struct { 1164 union { 1165 /* rate control */ 1166 struct { 1167 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[ 1168 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1169 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx; 1170 u8 use_rts:1; 1171 u8 use_cts_prot:1; 1172 u8 short_preamble:1; 1173 u8 skip_table:1; 1174 /* 2 bytes free */ 1175 }; 1176 /* only needed before rate control */ 1177 unsigned long jiffies; 1178 }; 1179 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */ 1180 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 1181 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key; 1182 u32 flags; 1183 codel_time_t enqueue_time; 1184 } control; 1185 struct { 1186 u64 cookie; 1187 } ack; 1188 struct { 1189 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1190 s32 ack_signal; 1191 u8 ampdu_ack_len; 1192 u8 ampdu_len; 1193 u8 antenna; 1194 u8 pad; 1195 u16 tx_time; 1196 u8 flags; 1197 u8 pad2; 1198 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)]; 1199 } status; 1200 struct { 1201 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[ 1202 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1203 u8 pad[4]; 1204 1205 void *rate_driver_data[ 1206 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; 1207 }; 1208 void *driver_data[ 1209 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; 1210 }; 1211 }; 1212 1213 static inline u16 1214 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est) 1215 { 1216 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime 1217 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1 1218 */ 1219 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2; 1220 return info->tx_time_est << 2; 1221 } 1222 1223 static inline u16 1224 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 1225 { 1226 return info->tx_time_est << 2; 1227 } 1228 1229 /*** 1230 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path 1231 * 1232 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a 1233 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet. 1234 * 1235 * @rate_idx The actual used rate. 1236 * @try_count How often the rate was tried. 1237 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the 1238 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level 1239 * that was used when sending the packet. 1240 */ 1241 struct ieee80211_rate_status { 1242 struct rate_info rate_idx; 1243 u8 try_count; 1244 u8 tx_power_idx; 1245 }; 1246 1247 /** 1248 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control 1249 * 1250 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for 1251 * @info: Basic tx status information 1252 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver) 1253 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet 1254 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates) 1255 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver 1256 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds 1257 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action 1258 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled. 1259 */ 1260 struct ieee80211_tx_status { 1261 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 1262 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info; 1263 struct sk_buff *skb; 1264 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates; 1265 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp; 1266 u8 n_rates; 1267 1268 struct list_head *free_list; 1269 }; 1270 1271 /** 1272 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs 1273 * 1274 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan 1275 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace 1276 * and the ones generated by mac80211. 1277 * 1278 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs. 1279 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs. 1280 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones) 1281 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies 1282 */ 1283 struct ieee80211_scan_ies { 1284 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 1285 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 1286 const u8 *common_ies; 1287 size_t common_ie_len; 1288 }; 1289 1290 1291 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb) 1292 { 1293 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb; 1294 } 1295 1296 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb) 1297 { 1298 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb; 1299 } 1300 1301 /** 1302 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status 1303 * 1304 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared. 1305 * 1306 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report 1307 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything 1308 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear 1309 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway). 1310 * 1311 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the 1312 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore 1313 * any fields it needs after calling this helper. 1314 */ 1315 static inline void 1316 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 1317 { 1318 int i; 1319 1320 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 1321 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates)); 1322 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 1323 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates)); 1324 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8); 1325 /* clear the rate counts */ 1326 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++) 1327 info->status.rates[i].count = 0; 1328 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates); 1329 } 1330 1331 1332 /** 1333 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags 1334 * 1335 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status. 1336 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame. 1337 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED. 1338 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware. 1339 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame, 1340 * verification has been done by the hardware. 1341 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame. 1342 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection 1343 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that. 1344 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this 1345 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection. 1346 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame 1347 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set) 1348 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did 1349 * de-duplication by itself. 1350 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on 1351 * the frame. 1352 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on 1353 * the frame. 1354 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1355 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU 1356 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS 1357 * merging. 1358 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1359 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU 1360 * (including FCS) was received. 1361 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1362 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received. 1363 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present. 1364 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU) 1365 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference 1366 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for 1367 * each A-MPDU 1368 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all 1369 * subframes of a single A-MPDU 1370 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU 1371 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected 1372 * on this subframe 1373 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC 1374 * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field) 1375 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was 1376 * done by the hardware 1377 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without 1378 * processing it in any regular way. 1379 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report 1380 * them for sniffing purposes. 1381 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except 1382 * monitor interfaces. 1383 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report 1384 * them for sniffing purposes. 1385 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU 1386 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons. 1387 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g. 1388 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while 1389 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to 1390 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU 1391 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be 1392 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be 1393 * interleaved with other frames. 1394 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the 1395 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header). 1396 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point 1397 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV 1398 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs 1399 * in the skb. 1400 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before. 1401 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as 1402 * the first subframe. 1403 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must 1404 * be done in the hardware. 1405 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this 1406 * frame 1407 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known 1408 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present 1409 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in 1410 * 1411 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS 1412 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM 1413 * - DATA3_CODING 1414 * - DATA5_GI 1415 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC 1416 * - DATA6_NSTS 1417 * - DATA3_STBC 1418 * 1419 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data) 1420 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present 1421 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu) 1422 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present 1423 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with 1424 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is 1425 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't 1426 * known the frame shouldn't be reported. 1427 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by 1428 * hardware or driver) 1429 */ 1430 enum mac80211_rx_flags { 1431 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0), 1432 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1), 1433 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = BIT(2), 1434 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3), 1435 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4), 1436 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5), 1437 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6), 1438 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = BIT(7), 1439 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8), 1440 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9), 1441 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10), 1442 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11), 1443 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12), 1444 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13), 1445 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14), 1446 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(15), 1447 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = BIT(16), 1448 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(17), 1449 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18), 1450 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19), 1451 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20), 1452 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21), 1453 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22), 1454 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23), 1455 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24), 1456 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25), 1457 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26), 1458 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27), 1459 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28), 1460 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29), 1461 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30), 1462 }; 1463 1464 /** 1465 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags 1466 * 1467 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame 1468 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used 1469 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission, 1470 * if the driver fills this value it should add 1471 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT 1472 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact. 1473 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used 1474 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3 1475 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed 1476 */ 1477 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags { 1478 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0), 1479 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1480 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3), 1481 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5), 1482 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6), 1483 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7), 1484 }; 1485 1486 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4 1487 1488 enum mac80211_rx_encoding { 1489 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0, 1490 RX_ENC_HT, 1491 RX_ENC_VHT, 1492 RX_ENC_HE, 1493 RX_ENC_EHT, 1494 }; 1495 1496 /** 1497 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status 1498 * 1499 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset 1500 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received 1501 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb). 1502 * 1503 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function 1504 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware. 1505 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is 1506 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache. 1507 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only 1508 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames. 1509 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled. 1510 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use 1511 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation 1512 * @band: the active band when this frame was received 1513 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz 1514 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed 1515 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting. 1516 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz. 1517 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or 1518 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags 1519 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_* 1520 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength 1521 * values were filled. 1522 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't 1523 * support dB or unspecified units) 1524 * @antenna: antenna used 1525 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if 1526 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT) 1527 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only) 1528 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\* 1529 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding 1530 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw 1531 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags 1532 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc 1533 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi 1534 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1535 * @eht: EHT specific rate information 1536 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc 1537 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi 1538 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211 1539 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for 1540 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU 1541 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC 1542 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU 1543 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag 1544 * is set only when connection is MLO. 1545 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with 1546 * @link_valid. 1547 */ 1548 struct ieee80211_rx_status { 1549 u64 mactime; 1550 union { 1551 u64 boottime_ns; 1552 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp; 1553 }; 1554 u32 device_timestamp; 1555 u32 ampdu_reference; 1556 u32 flag; 1557 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1; 1558 u8 enc_flags; 1559 u8 encoding:3, bw:4; 1560 union { 1561 struct { 1562 u8 he_ru:3; 1563 u8 he_gi:2; 1564 u8 he_dcm:1; 1565 }; 1566 struct { 1567 u8 ru:4; 1568 u8 gi:2; 1569 } eht; 1570 }; 1571 u8 rate_idx; 1572 u8 nss; 1573 u8 rx_flags; 1574 u8 band; 1575 u8 antenna; 1576 s8 signal; 1577 u8 chains; 1578 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1579 u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc; 1580 u8 zero_length_psdu_type; 1581 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4; 1582 }; 1583 1584 static inline u32 1585 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status) 1586 { 1587 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) + 1588 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0); 1589 } 1590 1591 /** 1592 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags 1593 * 1594 * Flags to define PHY configuration options 1595 * 1596 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this 1597 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets 1598 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags! 1599 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only). 1600 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2, 1601 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to 1602 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames. 1603 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states, 1604 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support" 1605 * for more. 1606 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set 1607 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but 1608 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will 1609 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but 1610 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active. 1611 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main 1612 * operating channel. 1613 */ 1614 enum ieee80211_conf_flags { 1615 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0), 1616 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1), 1617 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2), 1618 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3), 1619 }; 1620 1621 1622 /** 1623 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed 1624 * 1625 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed 1626 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed 1627 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed 1628 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed 1629 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed 1630 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed 1631 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed 1632 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed 1633 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, 1634 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. 1635 */ 1636 enum ieee80211_conf_changed { 1637 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1), 1638 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2), 1639 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3), 1640 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4), 1641 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5), 1642 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6), 1643 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7), 1644 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8), 1645 }; 1646 1647 /** 1648 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode 1649 * 1650 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic 1651 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off 1652 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static 1653 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic 1654 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use 1655 */ 1656 enum ieee80211_smps_mode { 1657 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC, 1658 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF, 1659 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC, 1660 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC, 1661 1662 /* keep last */ 1663 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES, 1664 }; 1665 1666 /** 1667 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device 1668 * 1669 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware. 1670 * 1671 * @flags: configuration flags defined above 1672 * 1673 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval 1674 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use 1675 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon 1676 * has been received and the DTIM period is known. 1677 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the 1678 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when 1679 * the CONF_PS flag is set. 1680 * 1681 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility 1682 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces 1683 * 1684 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to 1685 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled 1686 * 1687 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame 1688 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11, 1689 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries 1690 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short" 1691 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the 1692 * number of transmissions not the number of retries 1693 * 1694 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that 1695 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not 1696 * configured for an HT channel. 1697 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, 1698 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. 1699 */ 1700 struct ieee80211_conf { 1701 u32 flags; 1702 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout; 1703 1704 u16 listen_interval; 1705 u8 ps_dtim_period; 1706 1707 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count; 1708 1709 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1710 bool radar_enabled; 1711 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1712 }; 1713 1714 /** 1715 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data 1716 * 1717 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch 1718 * operation. 1719 * 1720 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization 1721 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch 1722 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter 1723 * the driver passed into mac80211. 1724 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the 1725 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211. 1726 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the 1727 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP. 1728 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to 1729 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event 1730 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in 1731 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new 1732 * channel, expressed in TU. 1733 */ 1734 struct ieee80211_channel_switch { 1735 u64 timestamp; 1736 u32 device_timestamp; 1737 bool block_tx; 1738 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1739 u8 count; 1740 u32 delay; 1741 }; 1742 1743 /** 1744 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags 1745 * 1746 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering 1747 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups 1748 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality 1749 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor 1750 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and 1751 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached. 1752 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this 1753 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition, 1754 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is 1755 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces. 1756 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes 1757 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even 1758 * this is not pure P2P vif. 1759 * @IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE: disable user configuration of 1760 * SMPS mode via debugfs. 1761 */ 1762 enum ieee80211_vif_flags { 1763 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0), 1764 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1), 1765 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2), 1766 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3), 1767 IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE = BIT(4), 1768 }; 1769 1770 1771 /** 1772 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags 1773 * 1774 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled 1775 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211. 1776 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface. 1777 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload 1778 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled 1779 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to 1780 * mac80211. 1781 */ 1782 1783 enum ieee80211_offload_flags { 1784 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0), 1785 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1), 1786 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2), 1787 }; 1788 1789 /** 1790 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration 1791 * @assoc: association status 1792 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not 1793 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created 1794 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by 1795 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations. 1796 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true 1797 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002k. 1798 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in 1799 * P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002j. 1800 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The 1801 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here. 1802 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here 1803 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass. 1804 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this 1805 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list 1806 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case. 1807 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode. 1808 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid. 1809 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format). 1810 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the 1811 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what 1812 * your driver/device needs to do. 1813 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections 1814 * (station mode only) 1815 */ 1816 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg { 1817 /* association related data */ 1818 bool assoc, ibss_joined; 1819 bool ibss_creator; 1820 bool ps; 1821 u16 aid; 1822 u16 eml_cap; 1823 u16 eml_med_sync_delay; 1824 1825 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN]; 1826 int arp_addr_cnt; 1827 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 1828 size_t ssid_len; 1829 bool s1g; 1830 bool idle; 1831 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 1832 }; 1833 1834 /** 1835 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data 1836 * 1837 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver 1838 * use during the life of a virtual interface. 1839 * 1840 * @type: type of this virtual interface 1841 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg 1842 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own 1843 * or the BSS we're associated to 1844 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration, 1845 * indexed by link ID 1846 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1847 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1848 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the 1849 * API calls meant for that purpose. 1850 * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1851 * Must be a subset of valid_links. 1852 * @addr: address of this interface 1853 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p 1854 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively 1855 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this 1856 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver 1857 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup 1858 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM) 1859 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface, 1860 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added 1861 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed 1862 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field 1863 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface. 1864 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface, 1865 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver 1866 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change 1867 * restrictions. 1868 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC 1869 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only 1870 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per 1871 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual 1872 * monitor interface (if that is requested.) 1873 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this 1874 * interface. 1875 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211 1876 * for this interface. 1877 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 1878 * sizeof(void \*). 1879 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue 1880 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see 1881 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags. 1882 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled. 1883 */ 1884 struct ieee80211_vif { 1885 enum nl80211_iftype type; 1886 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg; 1887 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf; 1888 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 1889 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links; 1890 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 1891 bool p2p; 1892 1893 u8 cab_queue; 1894 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS]; 1895 1896 struct ieee80211_txq *txq; 1897 1898 netdev_features_t netdev_features; 1899 u32 driver_flags; 1900 u32 offload_flags; 1901 1902 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS 1903 struct dentry *debugfs_dir; 1904 #endif 1905 1906 bool probe_req_reg; 1907 bool rx_mcast_action_reg; 1908 1909 struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif; 1910 1911 /* must be last */ 1912 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 1913 }; 1914 1915 /** 1916 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif 1917 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested 1918 * Return: the usable link bitmap 1919 */ 1920 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1921 { 1922 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links; 1923 } 1924 1925 /** 1926 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one 1927 * @vif: the vif 1928 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise. 1929 */ 1930 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1931 { 1932 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */ 1933 return vif->valid_links != 0; 1934 } 1935 1936 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \ 1937 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \ 1938 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \ 1939 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \ 1940 (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id]))) 1941 1942 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1943 { 1944 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH 1945 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT; 1946 #endif 1947 return false; 1948 } 1949 1950 /** 1951 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev 1952 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for 1953 * 1954 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs 1955 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev. 1956 * 1957 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't 1958 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor 1959 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.) 1960 */ 1961 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 1962 1963 /** 1964 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif 1965 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for 1966 * 1967 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs 1968 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif. 1969 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif. 1970 */ 1971 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 1972 1973 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1974 { 1975 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx); 1976 } 1977 1978 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \ 1979 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \ 1980 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif)) 1981 1982 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \ 1983 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \ 1984 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif)) 1985 1986 /** 1987 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags 1988 * 1989 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver 1990 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf. 1991 * 1992 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the 1993 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this 1994 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs 1995 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC. 1996 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by 1997 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC 1998 * generation in software. 1999 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates 2000 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key. 2001 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a 2002 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames 2003 * (MFP) to be done in software. 2004 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver 2005 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV 2006 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with 2007 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does 2008 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or 2009 * MIC. 2010 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received 2011 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware 2012 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames 2013 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and 2014 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with 2015 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the 2016 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW. 2017 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the 2018 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation 2019 * only for management frames (MFP). 2020 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the 2021 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always 2022 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled. 2023 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for 2024 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with 2025 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key. 2026 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation. 2027 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver 2028 * for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number 2029 * generation only 2030 */ 2031 enum ieee80211_key_flags { 2032 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0), 2033 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1), 2034 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2), 2035 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3), 2036 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4), 2037 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5), 2038 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6), 2039 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7), 2040 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8), 2041 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9), 2042 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10), 2043 }; 2044 2045 /** 2046 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information 2047 * 2048 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by 2049 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops. 2050 * 2051 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver 2052 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be 2053 * encrypted in hardware. 2054 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector. 2055 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it 2056 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO) 2057 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags. 2058 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3) 2059 * @keylen: key material length 2060 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte) 2061 * data block: 2062 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits) 2063 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits) 2064 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits) 2065 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type 2066 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type 2067 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys 2068 */ 2069 struct ieee80211_key_conf { 2070 atomic64_t tx_pn; 2071 u32 cipher; 2072 u8 icv_len; 2073 u8 iv_len; 2074 u8 hw_key_idx; 2075 s8 keyidx; 2076 u16 flags; 2077 s8 link_id; 2078 u8 keylen; 2079 u8 key[]; 2080 }; 2081 2082 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16 2083 2084 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff)) 2085 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff)) 2086 2087 /** 2088 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter 2089 * 2090 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order 2091 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2092 * reverse order than in packet) 2093 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2094 * reverse order than in packet) 2095 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2096 * reverse order than in packet) 2097 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2098 * reverse order than in packet) 2099 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys 2100 */ 2101 struct ieee80211_key_seq { 2102 union { 2103 struct { 2104 u32 iv32; 2105 u16 iv16; 2106 } tkip; 2107 struct { 2108 u8 pn[6]; 2109 } ccmp; 2110 struct { 2111 u8 pn[6]; 2112 } aes_cmac; 2113 struct { 2114 u8 pn[6]; 2115 } aes_gmac; 2116 struct { 2117 u8 pn[6]; 2118 } gcmp; 2119 struct { 2120 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN]; 2121 u8 seq_len; 2122 } hw; 2123 }; 2124 }; 2125 2126 /** 2127 * enum set_key_cmd - key command 2128 * 2129 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this 2130 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added. 2131 * 2132 * @SET_KEY: a key is set 2133 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled 2134 */ 2135 enum set_key_cmd { 2136 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY, 2137 }; 2138 2139 /** 2140 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state 2141 * 2142 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all, 2143 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions 2144 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state 2145 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated 2146 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated 2147 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X) 2148 */ 2149 enum ieee80211_sta_state { 2150 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */ 2151 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST, 2152 IEEE80211_STA_NONE, 2153 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH, 2154 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC, 2155 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED, 2156 }; 2157 2158 /** 2159 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth 2160 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz 2161 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz 2162 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz 2163 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz 2164 * (including 80+80 MHz) 2165 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz 2166 * 2167 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized 2168 * correctly, the values must be sorted. 2169 */ 2170 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth { 2171 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0, 2172 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40, 2173 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80, 2174 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160, 2175 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320, 2176 }; 2177 2178 /** 2179 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table 2180 * 2181 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update 2182 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default. 2183 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control. 2184 */ 2185 struct ieee80211_sta_rates { 2186 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2187 struct { 2188 s8 idx; 2189 u8 count; 2190 u8 count_cts; 2191 u8 count_rts; 2192 u16 flags; 2193 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE]; 2194 }; 2195 2196 /** 2197 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 2198 * 2199 * Used to configure txpower for station. 2200 * 2201 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames 2202 * to the STA. 2203 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 2204 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 2205 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 2206 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 2207 * per peer TPC. 2208 */ 2209 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr { 2210 s16 power; 2211 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 2212 }; 2213 2214 /** 2215 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links 2216 * 2217 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the 2218 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change. 2219 * 2220 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes. 2221 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble. 2222 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply: 2223 * 2224 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the 2225 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes. 2226 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal 2227 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes. 2228 * 2229 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level 2230 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section 2231 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2). 2232 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control. 2233 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID 2234 */ 2235 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates { 2236 u16 max_amsdu_len; 2237 2238 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len; 2239 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS]; 2240 }; 2241 2242 /** 2243 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info 2244 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single) 2245 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here. 2246 * 2247 * @sta: reference to owning STA 2248 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr 2249 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different 2250 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr) 2251 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink) 2252 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic) 2253 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates 2254 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities 2255 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities 2256 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA 2257 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities 2258 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA 2259 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation 2260 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with 2261 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the 2262 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode 2263 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after 2264 * the station moves to associated state. 2265 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration 2266 * 2267 */ 2268 struct ieee80211_link_sta { 2269 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2270 2271 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 2272 u8 link_id; 2273 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 2274 2275 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2276 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 2277 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 2278 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 2279 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 2280 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap; 2281 2282 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg; 2283 2284 u8 rx_nss; 2285 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth; 2286 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr; 2287 }; 2288 2289 /** 2290 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry 2291 * 2292 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly 2293 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in 2294 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must 2295 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly, 2296 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a 2297 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it. 2298 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association 2299 * and holds pointers to various link STA's 2300 * 2301 * @addr: MAC address 2302 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP 2303 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU 2304 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us. 2305 * Can be modified by driver. 2306 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does, 2307 * otherwise always false) 2308 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 2309 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information. 2310 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid 2311 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in 2312 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*. 2313 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported. 2314 * @rates: rate control selection table 2315 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer 2316 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only 2317 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place. 2318 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not. 2319 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station. 2320 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single 2321 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means 2322 * unlimited. 2323 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links 2324 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA 2325 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it. 2326 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not. 2327 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) 2328 * is used for non-data frames 2329 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link 2330 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through 2331 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA 2332 * the first added link STA will point to deflink. 2333 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link, 2334 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and 2335 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO 2336 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to 2337 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address 2338 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned 2339 * by the AP. 2340 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO 2341 */ 2342 struct ieee80211_sta { 2343 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 2344 u16 aid; 2345 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; 2346 bool wme; 2347 u8 uapsd_queues; 2348 u8 max_sp; 2349 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates; 2350 bool tdls; 2351 bool tdls_initiator; 2352 bool mfp; 2353 bool mlo; 2354 u8 max_amsdu_subframes; 2355 2356 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur; 2357 2358 bool support_p2p_ps; 2359 2360 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1]; 2361 2362 u16 valid_links; 2363 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink; 2364 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 2365 2366 /* must be last */ 2367 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2368 }; 2369 2370 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP 2371 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 2372 #else 2373 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta) 2374 { 2375 return true; 2376 } 2377 #endif 2378 2379 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \ 2380 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \ 2381 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta)) 2382 2383 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \ 2384 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \ 2385 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta)) 2386 2387 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \ 2388 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \ 2389 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \ 2390 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \ 2391 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id))) 2392 2393 /** 2394 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command 2395 * 2396 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this 2397 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition. 2398 * 2399 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping 2400 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up 2401 */ 2402 enum sta_notify_cmd { 2403 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE, 2404 }; 2405 2406 /** 2407 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data 2408 * 2409 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and 2410 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU. 2411 */ 2412 struct ieee80211_tx_control { 2413 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2414 }; 2415 2416 /** 2417 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue 2418 * 2419 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 2420 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue 2421 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue), 2422 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled) 2423 * @ac: the AC for this queue 2424 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size 2425 * 2426 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling 2427 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). 2428 */ 2429 struct ieee80211_txq { 2430 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 2431 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2432 u8 tid; 2433 u8 ac; 2434 2435 /* must be last */ 2436 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2437 }; 2438 2439 /** 2440 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags 2441 * 2442 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to 2443 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning 2444 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting 2445 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule, 2446 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully. 2447 * 2448 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL: 2449 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be 2450 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm 2451 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace 2452 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control 2453 * algorithm. 2454 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of 2455 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have 2456 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config 2457 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot 2458 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for 2459 * CCK frames. 2460 * 2461 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS: 2462 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include 2463 * the FCS at the end. 2464 * 2465 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING: 2466 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames 2467 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others 2468 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used 2469 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and 2470 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that 2471 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(). 2472 * 2473 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: 2474 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We 2475 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal. 2476 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead. 2477 * 2478 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM: 2479 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from 2480 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized 2481 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set. 2482 * 2483 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT: 2484 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h 2485 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC 2486 * 2487 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION: 2488 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation. 2489 * 2490 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS: 2491 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep). 2492 * 2493 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK: 2494 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies 2495 * stack support for dynamic PS. 2496 * 2497 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS: 2498 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS. 2499 * 2500 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE: 2501 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w). 2502 * 2503 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS: 2504 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to 2505 * the stack. 2506 * 2507 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR: 2508 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including 2509 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss. 2510 * 2511 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC: 2512 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e. 2513 * dtim_period). 2514 * 2515 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports 2516 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If 2517 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not 2518 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still 2519 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag 2520 * only in that case. 2521 * 2522 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device 2523 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When 2524 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected 2525 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames. 2526 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure 2527 * the PS mode of connected stations. 2528 * 2529 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session 2530 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in 2531 * software. 2532 * 2533 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of 2534 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only 2535 * active interfaces. 2536 * 2537 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to 2538 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as 2539 * desired (and thus have them named as desired). 2540 * 2541 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the 2542 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically 2543 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if 2544 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its 2545 * supported cipher suites. 2546 * 2547 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit, 2548 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration 2549 * for frames. 2550 * 2551 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface 2552 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC) 2553 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue 2554 * control for more details. 2555 * 2556 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate 2557 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm. 2558 * 2559 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any 2560 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface 2561 * is supported. 2562 * 2563 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames 2564 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon. 2565 * 2566 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates 2567 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not 2568 * using aggregation for such frames.) 2569 * 2570 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA) 2571 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support 2572 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the 2573 * CSA frame. 2574 * 2575 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload 2576 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first. 2577 * 2578 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands 2579 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band. 2580 * 2581 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth 2582 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel. 2583 * 2584 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs 2585 * within A-MPDU. 2586 * 2587 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status 2588 * for sent beacons. 2589 * 2590 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each 2591 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified 2592 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station 2593 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time. 2594 * 2595 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the 2596 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in 2597 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session 2598 * timeout. 2599 * 2600 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX, 2601 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics. 2602 * 2603 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated 2604 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support. 2605 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must 2606 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting 2607 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta. 2608 * 2609 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list 2610 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU. 2611 * 2612 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event 2613 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such 2614 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver 2615 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout. 2616 * 2617 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself. 2618 * The stack will not do fragmentation. 2619 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well. 2620 * 2621 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on 2622 * TDLS links. 2623 * 2624 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the 2625 * mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a 2626 * deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no 2627 * beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the 2628 * virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of 2629 * the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the 2630 * deauthentication frame might not be transmitted. 2631 * 2632 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't 2633 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug. 2634 * 2635 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of 2636 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with. 2637 * 2638 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT 2639 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if 2640 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW 2641 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver. 2642 * See also the documentation for that flag. 2643 * 2644 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all 2645 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use 2646 * TXQs to start with. 2647 * 2648 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU 2649 * length in tx status information 2650 * 2651 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID 2652 * 2653 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID 2654 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set. 2655 * 2656 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only 2657 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx 2658 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID. 2659 * 2660 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation 2661 * offload 2662 * 2663 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation 2664 * offload 2665 * 2666 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx 2667 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface. 2668 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real 2669 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to 2670 * the stack. 2671 * 2672 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color 2673 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software. 2674 * 2675 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting 2676 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that. 2677 * 2678 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays 2679 */ 2680 enum ieee80211_hw_flags { 2681 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL, 2682 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS, 2683 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING, 2684 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC, 2685 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM, 2686 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC, 2687 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT, 2688 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION, 2689 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS, 2690 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK, 2691 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS, 2692 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE, 2693 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF, 2694 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF, 2695 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL, 2696 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT, 2697 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS, 2698 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR, 2699 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL, 2700 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK, 2701 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, 2702 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW, 2703 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE, 2704 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF, 2705 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY, 2706 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES, 2707 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA, 2708 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS, 2709 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS, 2710 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW, 2711 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU, 2712 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS, 2713 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR, 2714 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER, 2715 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS, 2716 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU, 2717 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST, 2718 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK, 2719 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG, 2720 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA, 2721 IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, 2722 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP, 2723 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ, 2724 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW, 2725 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ, 2726 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN, 2727 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID, 2728 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID, 2729 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT, 2730 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD, 2731 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD, 2732 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP, 2733 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION, 2734 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX, 2735 2736 /* keep last, obviously */ 2737 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS 2738 }; 2739 2740 /** 2741 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state 2742 * 2743 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware 2744 * information for an 802.11 PHY. 2745 * 2746 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this 2747 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev 2748 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV() 2749 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported 2750 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here. 2751 * 2752 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use. 2753 * 2754 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use 2755 * along with this structure. 2756 * 2757 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags. 2758 * 2759 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb 2760 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.) 2761 * 2762 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb. 2763 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs. 2764 * 2765 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used 2766 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB 2767 * 2768 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval 2769 * that HW supports 2770 * 2771 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for 2772 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these 2773 * queues need to have configurable access parameters. 2774 * 2775 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware. 2776 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be 2777 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw(). 2778 * 2779 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2780 * within &struct ieee80211_vif. 2781 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2782 * within &struct ieee80211_sta. 2783 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2784 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf. 2785 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2786 * within @struct ieee80211_txq. 2787 * 2788 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw 2789 * can handle. 2790 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages 2791 * the hw can report back. 2792 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage 2793 * 2794 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of 2795 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver 2796 * aggregation. 2797 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the 2798 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering 2799 * it shouldn't be set. 2800 * 2801 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an 2802 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll 2803 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if 2804 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N 2805 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012). 2806 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used. 2807 * 2808 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum 2809 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list. 2810 * 2811 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX 2812 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set) 2813 * 2814 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW 2815 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't 2816 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only 2817 * adding _BW is supported today. 2818 * 2819 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports, 2820 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH. 2821 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values. 2822 * 2823 * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags 2824 * 2825 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the 2826 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp 2827 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status 2828 * device_timestamp. 2829 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a 2830 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a 2831 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value. 2832 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the 2833 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set. 2834 * 2835 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created 2836 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211, 2837 * other features will be rejected during HW registration. 2838 * 2839 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate 2840 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery- 2841 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap. 2842 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means 2843 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means 2844 * neither enabled. 2845 * 2846 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may 2847 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA. 2848 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values. 2849 * 2850 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the 2851 * device. 2852 * 2853 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from 2854 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed, 2855 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers. 2856 * 2857 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while 2858 * refilling deficit of each TXQ. 2859 * 2860 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set. 2861 * 2862 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware. 2863 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions. 2864 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level. 2865 * 2866 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list. 2867 */ 2868 struct ieee80211_hw { 2869 struct ieee80211_conf conf; 2870 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2871 const char *rate_control_algorithm; 2872 void *priv; 2873 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)]; 2874 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom; 2875 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom; 2876 int vif_data_size; 2877 int sta_data_size; 2878 int chanctx_data_size; 2879 int txq_data_size; 2880 u16 queues; 2881 u16 max_listen_interval; 2882 s8 max_signal; 2883 u8 max_rates; 2884 u8 max_report_rates; 2885 u8 max_rate_tries; 2886 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; 2887 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes; 2888 u8 max_tx_fragments; 2889 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue; 2890 u8 radiotap_mcs_details; 2891 u16 radiotap_vht_details; 2892 struct { 2893 int units_pos; 2894 s16 accuracy; 2895 } radiotap_timestamp; 2896 netdev_features_t netdev_features; 2897 u8 uapsd_queues; 2898 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len; 2899 u8 max_nan_de_entries; 2900 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift; 2901 u8 weight_multiplier; 2902 u32 max_mtu; 2903 const s8 *tx_power_levels; 2904 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx; 2905 }; 2906 2907 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2908 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg) 2909 { 2910 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags); 2911 } 2912 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg) 2913 2914 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2915 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg) 2916 { 2917 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags); 2918 } 2919 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg) 2920 2921 /** 2922 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request 2923 * 2924 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie) 2925 * @req: cfg80211 request. 2926 */ 2927 struct ieee80211_scan_request { 2928 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies; 2929 2930 /* Keep last */ 2931 struct cfg80211_scan_request req; 2932 }; 2933 2934 /** 2935 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters 2936 * 2937 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from 2938 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request 2939 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode 2940 * @status: channel-switch response status 2941 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received 2942 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame 2943 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame 2944 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template 2945 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb 2946 */ 2947 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params { 2948 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2949 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef; 2950 u8 action_code; 2951 u32 status; 2952 u32 timestamp; 2953 u16 switch_time; 2954 u16 switch_timeout; 2955 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb; 2956 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie; 2957 }; 2958 2959 /** 2960 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy 2961 * 2962 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query 2963 * 2964 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective 2965 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private 2966 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should 2967 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this 2968 * is already used internally by mac80211. 2969 * 2970 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy. 2971 */ 2972 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy); 2973 2974 /** 2975 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware 2976 * 2977 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for 2978 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device 2979 */ 2980 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev) 2981 { 2982 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev); 2983 } 2984 2985 /** 2986 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware 2987 * 2988 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for 2989 * @addr: the address to set 2990 */ 2991 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr) 2992 { 2993 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN); 2994 } 2995 2996 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 2997 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2998 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) 2999 { 3000 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0)) 3001 return NULL; 3002 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx]; 3003 } 3004 3005 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 3006 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3007 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) 3008 { 3009 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0) 3010 return NULL; 3011 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx]; 3012 } 3013 3014 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * 3015 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3016 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx) 3017 { 3018 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0) 3019 return NULL; 3020 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx]; 3021 } 3022 3023 /** 3024 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb 3025 * @hw: the hardware 3026 * @skb: the skb 3027 * 3028 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure 3029 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported. 3030 */ 3031 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); 3032 3033 /** 3034 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration 3035 * 3036 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware 3037 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations. 3038 * 3039 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given 3040 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and 3041 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL 3042 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to 3043 * the station information for the peer for individual keys. 3044 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when 3045 * VLANs are configured for an access point. 3046 * 3047 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx 3048 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf 3049 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function. 3050 * 3051 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if 3052 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be 3053 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the 3054 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range. 3055 * 3056 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is 3057 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if 3058 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the 3059 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software. 3060 * 3061 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed. 3062 * 3063 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key 3064 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any 3065 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather 3066 * based on the receive flags. 3067 * 3068 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key 3069 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key() 3070 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate 3071 * keys. 3072 * 3073 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption 3074 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key 3075 * handler. 3076 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key. 3077 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The 3078 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did 3079 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is 3080 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this 3081 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16. 3082 * 3083 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index 3084 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required 3085 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses). 3086 * 3087 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag 3088 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following 3089 * requirements: 3090 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211 3091 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed, 3092 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued 3093 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits), 3094 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command 3095 encrypted with the new key when also needing 3096 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and 3097 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted. 3098 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver. 3099 */ 3100 3101 /** 3102 * DOC: Powersave support 3103 * 3104 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations. 3105 * 3106 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself, 3107 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware 3108 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode 3109 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status. 3110 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary, 3111 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required 3112 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when 3113 * it finds traffic directed to it. 3114 * 3115 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in 3116 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused 3117 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking 3118 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it 3119 * back to sleep at appropriate times. 3120 * 3121 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the 3122 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be 3123 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame. 3124 * 3125 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also 3126 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported 3127 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and 3128 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still 3129 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle 3130 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that 3131 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that. 3132 * 3133 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the 3134 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a 3135 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to 3136 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when 3137 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle 3138 * periods. 3139 * 3140 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling 3141 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS 3142 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally, 3143 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the 3144 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support 3145 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the 3146 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value 3147 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable 3148 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS 3149 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave. 3150 * 3151 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling 3152 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the 3153 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS 3154 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To 3155 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames 3156 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled. 3157 * 3158 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with 3159 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK. 3160 */ 3161 3162 /** 3163 * DOC: Beacon filter support 3164 * 3165 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups 3166 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that 3167 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly 3168 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the 3169 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That 3170 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information 3171 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed. 3172 * 3173 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER 3174 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support 3175 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When 3176 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the 3177 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss(). 3178 * 3179 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the 3180 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call 3181 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled 3182 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future. 3183 * 3184 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing 3185 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211 3186 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense 3187 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include 3188 * 3189 * - a list of information element IDs 3190 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element 3191 * 3192 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the 3193 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense 3194 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device 3195 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all 3196 * vendor information elements. 3197 * 3198 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information 3199 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon. 3200 * 3201 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing 3202 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing 3203 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and 3204 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136, 3205 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility 3206 * it could also include some currently unused IDs. 3207 * 3208 * 3209 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the 3210 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming 3211 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of 3212 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when 3213 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above 3214 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be 3215 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement 3216 * them as the roaming algorithm requires. 3217 * 3218 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to 3219 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the 3220 * signal strength threshold checking. 3221 */ 3222 3223 /** 3224 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save 3225 * 3226 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve 3227 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism 3228 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009) 3229 * "11.2.3 SM power save". 3230 * 3231 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames 3232 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct 3233 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the 3234 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware 3235 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by 3236 * hardware flags. 3237 * 3238 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211 3239 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS 3240 * turned off otherwise. 3241 * 3242 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate 3243 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config() 3244 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to 3245 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP. 3246 */ 3247 3248 /** 3249 * DOC: Frame filtering 3250 * 3251 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper 3252 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when 3253 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption, 3254 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is 3255 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible. 3256 * 3257 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell 3258 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be 3259 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out. 3260 * 3261 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast() 3262 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list 3263 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces. 3264 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to 3265 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the 3266 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and 3267 * @total_flags with the new flag states. 3268 * 3269 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will 3270 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count 3271 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted 3272 * or dropped. 3273 * 3274 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared. 3275 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_ 3276 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore 3277 * the flag, but not clear it. 3278 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the 3279 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type 3280 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it). 3281 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware 3282 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes 3283 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them, 3284 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag. 3285 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well. 3286 */ 3287 3288 /** 3289 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients 3290 * 3291 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for 3292 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD. 3293 * There currently is no support for sAPSD. 3294 * 3295 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client 3296 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time. 3297 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but 3298 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies 3299 * the driver code. 3300 * 3301 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete 3302 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set, 3303 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for 3304 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames. 3305 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of 3306 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't 3307 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD. 3308 * 3309 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the 3310 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a 3311 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is, 3312 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is 3313 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this 3314 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to 3315 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will 3316 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The 3317 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its 3318 * @sta_notify callback. 3319 * 3320 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up, 3321 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period. 3322 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and 3323 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When 3324 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211 3325 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames 3326 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit 3327 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER 3328 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only 3329 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to 3330 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have 3331 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS. 3332 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is 3333 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer. 3334 * 3335 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by 3336 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them. 3337 * 3338 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi 3339 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up 3340 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being 3341 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong 3342 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be 3343 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to 3344 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can 3345 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it 3346 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames 3347 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again 3348 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked. 3349 * 3350 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any 3351 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is 3352 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any 3353 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up 3354 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when 3355 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service 3356 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called 3357 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are 3358 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting 3359 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames, 3360 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if 3361 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames 3362 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the 3363 * buffers for those TIDs contain. 3364 * 3365 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may 3366 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must 3367 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that 3368 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid 3369 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released 3370 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp() 3371 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway. 3372 * 3373 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211 3374 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags 3375 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) 3376 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame. 3377 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case. 3378 * 3379 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data 3380 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as 3381 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame 3382 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed. 3383 */ 3384 3385 /** 3386 * DOC: HW queue control 3387 * 3388 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static 3389 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This 3390 * was problematic for a few reasons: 3391 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames 3392 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly 3393 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames 3394 * 3395 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all 3396 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it 3397 * won't have the same problem with the software queues. 3398 * 3399 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability 3400 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do 3401 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif 3402 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will 3403 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and 3404 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors 3405 * the hardware queue. 3406 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue 3407 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.) 3408 * 3409 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual 3410 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to 3411 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a 3412 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have 3413 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios: 3414 * 3415 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3 3416 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7 3417 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8 3418 * off-channel queue: 9 3419 * 3420 * It would then set up the hardware like this: 3421 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9 3422 * 3423 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows: 3424 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0 3425 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1 3426 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2 3427 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3 3428 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 3429 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7. 3430 * 3431 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second 3432 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC. 3433 * 3434 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 3435 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the 3436 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when 3437 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode. 3438 */ 3439 3440 /** 3441 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags 3442 * 3443 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be 3444 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the 3445 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested, 3446 * but this has negative impact on power consumption. 3447 * 3448 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested 3449 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by 3450 * multicast address. 3451 * 3452 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the 3453 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them) 3454 * 3455 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set 3456 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them 3457 * 3458 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate 3459 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses 3460 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing 3461 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should 3462 * honour this flag if possible. 3463 * 3464 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this 3465 * station 3466 * 3467 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes 3468 * 3469 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames 3470 * 3471 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames 3472 * 3473 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames 3474 */ 3475 enum ieee80211_filter_flags { 3476 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1, 3477 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2, 3478 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3, 3479 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4, 3480 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5, 3481 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6, 3482 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7, 3483 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8, 3484 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9, 3485 }; 3486 3487 /** 3488 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions 3489 * 3490 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in 3491 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed. 3492 * 3493 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation 3494 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by 3495 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer 3496 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away! 3497 * 3498 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation 3499 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation 3500 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either 3501 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or 3502 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status 3503 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after 3504 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special 3505 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE. 3506 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational 3507 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting 3508 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the 3509 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(). 3510 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets, 3511 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call 3512 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the 3513 * session is gone and removes the station. 3514 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped 3515 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and 3516 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers 3517 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called. 3518 */ 3519 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action { 3520 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START, 3521 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP, 3522 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START, 3523 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT, 3524 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH, 3525 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT, 3526 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL, 3527 }; 3528 3529 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1 3530 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2 3531 3532 /** 3533 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters 3534 * 3535 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. 3536 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session 3537 * @tid: tid of the BA session 3538 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When 3539 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the 3540 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here. 3541 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the 3542 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or 3543 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL 3544 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU. 3545 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL 3546 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to 3547 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START 3548 */ 3549 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params { 3550 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action; 3551 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 3552 u16 tid; 3553 u16 ssn; 3554 u16 buf_size; 3555 bool amsdu; 3556 u16 timeout; 3557 }; 3558 3559 /** 3560 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason 3561 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll 3562 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to 3563 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC 3564 */ 3565 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type { 3566 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL, 3567 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD, 3568 }; 3569 3570 /** 3571 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed 3572 * 3573 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit 3574 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station 3575 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40 3576 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes. 3577 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed. 3578 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer 3579 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about 3580 * the peer. 3581 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed 3582 * by the peer 3583 */ 3584 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed { 3585 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 3586 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1), 3587 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2), 3588 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3), 3589 }; 3590 3591 /** 3592 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type 3593 * 3594 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations, 3595 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other 3596 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa). 3597 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC 3598 * operations compared to other operations/flows. 3599 * 3600 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC. 3601 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required 3602 * for sending management frames offchannel. 3603 */ 3604 enum ieee80211_roc_type { 3605 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0, 3606 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX, 3607 }; 3608 3609 /** 3610 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type 3611 * 3612 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what 3613 * reconfiguration type was completed. 3614 * 3615 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type 3616 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1) 3617 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless 3618 * of wowlan configuration) 3619 */ 3620 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type { 3621 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART, 3622 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND, 3623 }; 3624 3625 /** 3626 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information 3627 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration, 3628 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method. 3629 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc) 3630 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only 3631 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only 3632 * valid for auth and (re)assoc. 3633 */ 3634 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info { 3635 u16 duration; 3636 u16 subtype; 3637 u8 success:1; 3638 }; 3639 3640 /** 3641 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver 3642 * 3643 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may 3644 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure 3645 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame. 3646 * 3647 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame. 3648 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header. 3649 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on 3650 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should, 3651 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately. 3652 * Must be atomic. 3653 * 3654 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware 3655 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on 3656 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.) 3657 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace, 3658 * or zero. 3659 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address 3660 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device 3661 * is added. 3662 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3663 * 3664 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware 3665 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least 3666 * it must turn off frame reception.) 3667 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects 3668 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue 3669 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback. 3670 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3671 * 3672 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and 3673 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then 3674 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is 3675 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and 3676 * reconfigured at resume time. 3677 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it 3678 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only 3679 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it 3680 * must return 1 from this function. 3681 * 3682 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is 3683 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully 3684 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is 3685 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211 3686 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume. 3687 * 3688 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is 3689 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is 3690 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only 3691 * in suspend(). 3692 * 3693 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is 3694 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start 3695 * and @stop must be implemented. 3696 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before 3697 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the 3698 * interface is given in the conf parameter. 3699 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a 3700 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.) 3701 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3702 * 3703 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback 3704 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be 3705 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep. 3706 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be 3707 * found by the interface iteration callbacks. 3708 * 3709 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down. 3710 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface 3711 * and no monitor interfaces are present. 3712 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware 3713 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets, 3714 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the 3715 * MAC address of the device going away. 3716 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep. 3717 * 3718 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this 3719 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel. 3720 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code 3721 * if it does. The callback can sleep. 3722 * 3723 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS 3724 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low 3725 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters). 3726 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless 3727 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which 3728 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback 3729 * can sleep. 3730 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed 3731 * are not implemented. 3732 * 3733 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface 3734 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the 3735 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.) 3736 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed. 3737 * The callback can sleep. 3738 * 3739 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link 3740 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an 3741 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information. 3742 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id 3743 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for 3744 * non-MLO connections. 3745 * The callback can sleep. 3746 * 3747 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration. 3748 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed 3749 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic. 3750 * 3751 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter. 3752 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information. 3753 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep. 3754 * 3755 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter. 3756 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames 3757 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination 3758 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates 3759 * which flags are changed. 3760 * This callback can sleep. 3761 * 3762 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit 3763 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic. 3764 * 3765 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" 3766 * This callback is only called between add_interface and 3767 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface 3768 * is enabled. 3769 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added. 3770 * The callback can sleep. 3771 * 3772 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" 3773 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers 3774 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY. 3775 * The callback must be atomic. 3776 * 3777 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the 3778 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data 3779 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter. 3780 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify 3781 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(). 3782 * 3783 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for 3784 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP 3785 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it. 3786 * 3787 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start 3788 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel 3789 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's 3790 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure 3791 * that power save is disabled. 3792 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the 3793 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these 3794 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the 3795 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable). 3796 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called; 3797 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to 3798 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code. 3799 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1, 3800 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a 3801 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this 3802 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't 3803 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is. 3804 * The callback can sleep. 3805 * 3806 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan. 3807 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible), 3808 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call 3809 * ieee80211_scan_completed(). 3810 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new 3811 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended. 3812 * The callback can sleep. 3813 * 3814 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at 3815 * specific intervals. The driver must call the 3816 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results. 3817 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called. 3818 * 3819 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan. 3820 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called. 3821 * 3822 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan 3823 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification. 3824 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR, 3825 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it 3826 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep. 3827 * 3828 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a 3829 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need 3830 * this notification. 3831 * The callback can sleep. 3832 * 3833 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics. 3834 * Returns zero if statistics are available. 3835 * The callback can sleep. 3836 * 3837 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does 3838 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the 3839 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware. 3840 * The callback must be atomic. 3841 * 3842 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this 3843 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the 3844 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG 3845 * should be set as well. 3846 * The callback can sleep. 3847 * 3848 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it) 3849 * The callback can sleep. 3850 * 3851 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station, 3852 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep. 3853 * 3854 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated 3855 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback 3856 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected; 3857 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing 3858 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. 3859 * This callback can sleep. 3860 * 3861 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3862 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within 3863 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep. 3864 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf 3865 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory. 3866 * 3867 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3868 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback 3869 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This 3870 * callback can sleep. 3871 * 3872 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3873 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback 3874 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This 3875 * callback can sleep. 3876 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the 3877 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory. 3878 * 3879 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an 3880 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating 3881 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag 3882 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic. 3883 * 3884 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx 3885 * power for the station. 3886 * This callback can sleep. 3887 * 3888 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a 3889 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.) 3890 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove. 3891 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions 3892 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it 3893 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace 3894 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station. 3895 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. 3896 * The callback can sleep. 3897 * 3898 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU 3899 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station 3900 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear 3901 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse 3902 * in @sta_state. 3903 * The callback can sleep. 3904 * 3905 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be 3906 * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits 3907 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected 3908 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver 3909 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since 3910 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly. 3911 * Must be atomic. 3912 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This 3913 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses 3914 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic. 3915 * 3916 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon 3917 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so 3918 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of 3919 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not 3920 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible. 3921 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211. 3922 * The callback can sleep. 3923 * 3924 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max), 3925 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue. 3926 * Returns a negative error code on failure. 3927 * The callback can sleep. 3928 * 3929 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently, 3930 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a 3931 * required function. 3932 * The callback can sleep. 3933 * 3934 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware. 3935 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a 3936 * required function. 3937 * The callback can sleep. 3938 * 3939 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the 3940 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between 3941 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up 3942 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function. 3943 * The callback can sleep. 3944 * 3945 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize 3946 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This 3947 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of 3948 * TSF synchronization. 3949 * The callback can sleep. 3950 * 3951 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us. 3952 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is 3953 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests. 3954 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon. 3955 * The callback can sleep. 3956 * 3957 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information 3958 * 3959 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also 3960 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration, 3961 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback. 3962 * The callback can sleep. 3963 * 3964 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified 3965 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout 3966 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout 3967 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for 3968 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep. 3969 * 3970 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may 3971 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep. 3972 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep. 3973 * 3974 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure 3975 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap 3976 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces 3977 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues. 3978 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped. 3979 * Note that vif can be NULL. 3980 * The callback can sleep. 3981 * 3982 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for 3983 * the given station, as it's about to be removed. 3984 * The callback can sleep. 3985 * 3986 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel 3987 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this 3988 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate 3989 * completion of the channel switch. 3990 * 3991 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 3992 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 3993 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 3994 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 3995 * 3996 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 3997 * 3998 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must 3999 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note 4000 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw 4001 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted 4002 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the 4003 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call 4004 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(). 4005 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and 4006 * must be accepted in this case. 4007 * This callback may sleep. 4008 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is 4009 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep. 4010 * 4011 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes. 4012 * 4013 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes. 4014 * 4015 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware 4016 * queues before entering power save. 4017 * 4018 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection 4019 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled. 4020 * The callback can sleep. 4021 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See 4022 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types. 4023 * The callback must be atomic. 4024 * 4025 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given 4026 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for 4027 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver 4028 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD. 4029 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check 4030 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than 4031 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in 4032 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the 4033 * more-data bit must always be set. 4034 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames 4035 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set. 4036 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the 4037 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In 4038 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag 4039 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll 4040 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple 4041 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame. 4042 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be 4043 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send 4044 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for 4045 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the 4046 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP 4047 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function 4048 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP. 4049 * This callback must be atomic. 4050 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames 4051 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211 4052 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames 4053 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set 4054 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case 4055 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder 4056 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag 4057 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP 4058 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the 4059 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function. 4060 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the 4061 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set. 4062 * This callback must be atomic. 4063 * 4064 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count. 4065 * 4066 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats. 4067 * 4068 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats 4069 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets. 4070 * 4071 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association 4072 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is 4073 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated 4074 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any 4075 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's 4076 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a 4077 * management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the 4078 * driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response 4079 * and to be able to synchronize with the GO. 4080 * For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211 4081 * would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication 4082 * frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO. 4083 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return 4084 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away. 4085 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info 4086 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the 4087 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested. 4088 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep. 4089 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously 4090 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data 4091 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used. 4092 * 4093 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending 4094 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's 4095 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS 4096 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP. 4097 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS 4098 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least 4099 * 2 * (DTIM period). 4100 * The callback is optional and can sleep. 4101 * 4102 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation. 4103 * This callback may sleep. 4104 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction. 4105 * This callback may sleep. 4106 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that 4107 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same 4108 * channel context with different settings 4109 * This callback may sleep. 4110 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound 4111 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping. 4112 * This callback may sleep. 4113 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being 4114 * unbound from vif. 4115 * This callback may sleep. 4116 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to 4117 * another, as specified in the list of 4118 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according 4119 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode. 4120 * This callback may sleep. 4121 * 4122 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the 4123 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel 4124 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses 4125 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is 4126 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being 4127 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed. 4128 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface. 4129 * 4130 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and 4131 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed. 4132 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and 4133 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames). 4134 * This callback may sleep. 4135 * 4136 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed. 4137 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces. 4138 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep. 4139 * 4140 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel. 4141 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this 4142 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be 4143 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call 4144 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get() 4145 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is 4146 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been 4147 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish(). 4148 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called, 4149 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway. 4150 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4151 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA 4152 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing 4153 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch. 4154 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4155 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the 4156 * driver to go back to a normal configuration. 4157 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4158 * when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the 4159 * driver to go back to a normal configuration. 4160 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called 4161 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with 4162 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count. 4163 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all 4164 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A 4165 * channel context is bound before this is called. 4166 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again. 4167 * 4168 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the 4169 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0 4170 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide. 4171 * 4172 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration 4173 * and hardware limits. 4174 * 4175 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 4176 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 4177 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The 4178 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of 4179 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation. 4180 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can 4181 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use. 4182 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 4183 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 4184 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or 4185 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets 4186 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue 4187 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch 4188 * response template is provided, together with the location of the 4189 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within 4190 * the function call. 4191 * 4192 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue. 4193 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a 4194 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues 4195 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action 4196 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet. 4197 * 4198 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one. 4199 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster. 4200 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf 4201 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters 4202 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config. 4203 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since 4204 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the 4205 * changed parameters. 4206 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in 4207 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of 4208 * this call. 4209 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call 4210 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with 4211 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal. 4212 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports 4213 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation 4214 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while 4215 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU. 4216 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 4217 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 4218 * 4219 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep) 4220 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep) 4221 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep. 4222 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer. 4223 * This callback may sleep. 4224 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags 4225 * This callback may sleep. 4226 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using 4227 * 4-address mode 4228 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. 4229 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed 4230 * to use rx decapsulation offload 4231 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer. 4232 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters 4233 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement. 4234 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of 4235 * twt structure. 4236 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received 4237 * from the peer. 4238 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for 4239 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit 4240 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. 4241 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime 4242 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected 4243 * radar channel. 4244 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to 4245 * disable background CAC/radar detection. 4246 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to 4247 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading 4248 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while 4249 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer), 4250 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or 4251 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation. 4252 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures 4253 * that were already removed, in case they're needed. 4254 * This callback can sleep. 4255 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to 4256 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep. 4257 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links, 4258 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero. 4259 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them. 4260 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is 4261 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of 4262 * that. 4263 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware 4264 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif. 4265 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid 4266 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown. 4267 */ 4268 struct ieee80211_ops { 4269 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4270 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control, 4271 struct sk_buff *skb); 4272 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4273 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4274 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 4275 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan); 4276 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4277 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled); 4278 #endif 4279 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4280 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4281 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4282 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4283 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p); 4284 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4285 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4286 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed); 4287 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4288 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4289 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, 4290 u64 changed); 4291 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4292 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4293 u64 changed); 4294 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4295 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4296 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, 4297 u64 changed); 4298 4299 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4300 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4301 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4302 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4303 4304 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4305 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list); 4306 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4307 unsigned int changed_flags, 4308 unsigned int *total_flags, 4309 u64 multicast); 4310 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4311 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4312 unsigned int filter_flags, 4313 unsigned int changed_flags); 4314 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4315 bool set); 4316 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd, 4317 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4318 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key); 4319 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4320 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4321 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf, 4322 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4323 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key); 4324 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4325 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4326 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4327 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4328 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx); 4329 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4330 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req); 4331 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4332 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4333 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4334 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4335 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req, 4336 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies); 4337 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4338 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4339 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4340 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4341 const u8 *mac_addr); 4342 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4343 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4344 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4345 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats); 4346 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4347 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 4348 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 4349 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); 4350 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); 4351 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4352 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4353 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4354 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4355 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS 4356 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4357 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4358 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4359 struct dentry *dir); 4360 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4361 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4362 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4363 struct dentry *dir); 4364 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4365 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4366 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta, 4367 struct dentry *dir); 4368 #endif 4369 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4370 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4371 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4372 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4373 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4374 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4375 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4376 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state, 4377 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state); 4378 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4379 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4380 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4381 void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4382 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4383 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4384 u32 changed); 4385 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4386 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4387 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4388 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4389 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4390 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4391 struct station_info *sinfo); 4392 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4393 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4394 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac, 4395 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params); 4396 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4397 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4398 u64 tsf); 4399 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4400 s64 offset); 4401 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4402 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4403 4404 /** 4405 * @ampdu_action: 4406 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action. 4407 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want 4408 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through 4409 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. 4410 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver 4411 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size 4412 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the 4413 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be 4414 * possible with a buf_size of 8: 4415 * 4416 * - ``TX: 1.....7`` 4417 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1) 4418 * - ``TX: 8..1...`` 4419 * 4420 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the 4421 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be: 4422 * 4423 * - ``TX: 1 or`` 4424 * - ``TX: 18 or`` 4425 * - ``TX: 81`` 4426 * 4427 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again. 4428 * 4429 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return 4430 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START 4431 * if the session can start immediately. 4432 * 4433 * The callback can sleep. 4434 */ 4435 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4436 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4437 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params); 4438 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx, 4439 struct survey_info *survey); 4440 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4441 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class); 4442 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4443 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4444 void *data, int len); 4445 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb, 4446 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4447 void *data, int len); 4448 #endif 4449 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4450 u32 queues, bool drop); 4451 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4452 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4453 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4454 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4455 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4456 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4457 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4458 4459 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4460 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4461 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4462 int duration, 4463 enum ieee80211_roc_type type); 4464 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4465 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4466 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx); 4467 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4468 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max); 4469 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4470 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4471 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4472 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4473 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4474 const struct ieee80211_event *event); 4475 4476 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4477 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4478 u16 tids, int num_frames, 4479 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, 4480 bool more_data); 4481 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4482 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4483 u16 tids, int num_frames, 4484 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, 4485 bool more_data); 4486 4487 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4488 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset); 4489 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4490 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4491 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data); 4492 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4493 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4494 u32 sset, u8 *data); 4495 4496 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4497 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4498 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info); 4499 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4500 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4501 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info); 4502 4503 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4504 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4505 4506 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4507 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4508 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4509 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4510 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4511 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx, 4512 u32 changed); 4513 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4514 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4515 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4516 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4517 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4518 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4519 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4520 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4521 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4522 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs, 4523 int n_vifs, 4524 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode); 4525 4526 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4527 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type); 4528 4529 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6) 4530 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4531 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4532 struct inet6_dev *idev); 4533 #endif 4534 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4535 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4536 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4537 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4538 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4539 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4540 4541 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4542 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4543 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4544 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4545 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4546 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4547 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4548 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4549 4550 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4551 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4552 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4553 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4554 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4555 int *dbm); 4556 4557 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4558 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4559 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class, 4560 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4561 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie); 4562 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4563 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4564 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4565 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4566 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4567 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params); 4568 4569 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4570 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 4571 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4572 4573 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4574 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4575 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4576 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4577 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4578 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4579 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4580 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes); 4581 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4582 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4583 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4584 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4585 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4586 u8 instance_id); 4587 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4588 struct sk_buff *head, 4589 struct sk_buff *skb); 4590 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4591 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4592 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4593 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4594 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4595 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4596 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4597 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4598 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4599 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4600 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4601 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4602 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4603 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids); 4604 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4605 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4606 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4607 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled); 4608 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4609 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); 4610 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4611 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4612 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled); 4613 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4614 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4615 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt); 4616 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4617 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid); 4618 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4619 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4620 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4621 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4622 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4623 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx, 4624 struct net_device_path *path); 4625 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4626 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4627 u16 old_links, u16 new_links, 4628 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]); 4629 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4630 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4631 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4632 u16 old_links, u16 new_links); 4633 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4634 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4635 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts); 4636 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4637 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4638 struct net_device *dev, 4639 enum tc_setup_type type, 4640 void *type_data); 4641 }; 4642 4643 /** 4644 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device 4645 * 4646 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer 4647 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. 4648 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by 4649 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as 4650 * @priv_data_len. 4651 * 4652 * @priv_data_len: length of private data 4653 * @ops: callbacks for this device 4654 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device. 4655 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d) 4656 * 4657 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. 4658 */ 4659 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len, 4660 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops, 4661 const char *requested_name); 4662 4663 /** 4664 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device 4665 * 4666 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer 4667 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. 4668 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by 4669 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as 4670 * @priv_data_len. 4671 * 4672 * @priv_data_len: length of private data 4673 * @ops: callbacks for this device 4674 * 4675 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. 4676 */ 4677 static inline 4678 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len, 4679 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops) 4680 { 4681 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL); 4682 } 4683 4684 /** 4685 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device 4686 * 4687 * You must call this function before any other functions in 4688 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you 4689 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information. 4690 * 4691 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw() 4692 * 4693 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise. 4694 */ 4695 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4696 4697 /** 4698 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description 4699 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec 4700 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds 4701 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period) 4702 */ 4703 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink { 4704 int throughput; 4705 int blink_time; 4706 }; 4707 4708 /** 4709 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags 4710 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio 4711 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working 4712 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one 4713 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP 4714 */ 4715 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags { 4716 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0), 4717 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1), 4718 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2), 4719 }; 4720 4721 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4722 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4723 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4724 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4725 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4726 const char * 4727 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4728 unsigned int flags, 4729 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, 4730 unsigned int blink_table_len); 4731 #endif 4732 /** 4733 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED 4734 * 4735 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4736 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4737 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4738 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4739 * 4740 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4741 * 4742 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4743 */ 4744 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4745 { 4746 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4747 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw); 4748 #else 4749 return NULL; 4750 #endif 4751 } 4752 4753 /** 4754 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED 4755 * 4756 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4757 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4758 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4759 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4760 * 4761 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4762 * 4763 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4764 */ 4765 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4766 { 4767 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4768 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw); 4769 #else 4770 return NULL; 4771 #endif 4772 } 4773 4774 /** 4775 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED 4776 * 4777 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4778 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4779 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4780 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4781 * 4782 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4783 * 4784 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4785 */ 4786 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4787 { 4788 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4789 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw); 4790 #else 4791 return NULL; 4792 #endif 4793 } 4794 4795 /** 4796 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED 4797 * 4798 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4799 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4800 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4801 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4802 * 4803 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4804 * 4805 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4806 */ 4807 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4808 { 4809 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4810 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw); 4811 #else 4812 return NULL; 4813 #endif 4814 } 4815 4816 /** 4817 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger 4818 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for 4819 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags 4820 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput 4821 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table 4822 * 4823 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are 4824 * configured) or the name of the new trigger. 4825 * 4826 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw(). 4827 */ 4828 static inline const char * 4829 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags, 4830 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, 4831 unsigned int blink_table_len) 4832 { 4833 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4834 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table, 4835 blink_table_len); 4836 #else 4837 return NULL; 4838 #endif 4839 } 4840 4841 /** 4842 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device 4843 * 4844 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources 4845 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem. 4846 * 4847 * @hw: the hardware to unregister 4848 */ 4849 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4850 4851 /** 4852 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor 4853 * 4854 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the 4855 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw() 4856 * before calling this function. 4857 * 4858 * @hw: the hardware to free 4859 */ 4860 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4861 4862 /** 4863 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely 4864 * 4865 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason 4866 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state 4867 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware 4868 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by 4869 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all 4870 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function. 4871 * 4872 * @hw: the hardware to restart 4873 */ 4874 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4875 4876 /** 4877 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list 4878 * 4879 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4880 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4881 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4882 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4883 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4884 * 4885 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4886 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4887 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4888 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4889 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4890 * 4891 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock 4892 * 4893 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4894 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL 4895 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4896 * @list: the destination list 4897 */ 4898 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4899 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list); 4900 4901 /** 4902 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context 4903 * 4904 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4905 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4906 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4907 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4908 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4909 * 4910 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4911 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4912 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4913 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4914 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4915 * 4916 * This function must be called with BHs disabled. 4917 * 4918 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4919 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL 4920 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4921 * @napi: the NAPI context 4922 */ 4923 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4924 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi); 4925 4926 /** 4927 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame 4928 * 4929 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4930 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4931 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4932 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4933 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4934 * 4935 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4936 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4937 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4938 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4939 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4940 * 4941 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni(). 4942 * 4943 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4944 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4945 */ 4946 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb) 4947 { 4948 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL); 4949 } 4950 4951 /** 4952 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame 4953 * 4954 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context 4955 * (internally defers to a tasklet.) 4956 * 4957 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not 4958 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with 4959 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4960 * 4961 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4962 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4963 */ 4964 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); 4965 4966 /** 4967 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context) 4968 * 4969 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context 4970 * (internally disables bottom halves). 4971 * 4972 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may 4973 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4974 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4975 * 4976 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4977 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4978 */ 4979 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4980 struct sk_buff *skb) 4981 { 4982 local_bh_disable(); 4983 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb); 4984 local_bh_enable(); 4985 } 4986 4987 /** 4988 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta 4989 * 4990 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS 4991 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station 4992 * entering/leaving PS mode. 4993 * 4994 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled. 4995 * 4996 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against 4997 * each other. 4998 * 4999 * @sta: currently connected sta 5000 * @start: start or stop PS 5001 * 5002 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set. 5003 */ 5004 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start); 5005 5006 /** 5007 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta 5008 * (in process context) 5009 * 5010 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context 5011 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still 5012 * applies. 5013 * 5014 * @sta: currently connected sta 5015 * @start: start or stop PS 5016 * 5017 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(). 5018 */ 5019 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5020 bool start) 5021 { 5022 int ret; 5023 5024 local_bh_disable(); 5025 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start); 5026 local_bh_enable(); 5027 5028 return ret; 5029 } 5030 5031 /** 5032 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received 5033 * @sta: currently connected station 5034 * 5035 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set, 5036 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a 5037 * connected station was received. 5038 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() 5039 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must 5040 * be serialized. 5041 */ 5042 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 5043 5044 /** 5045 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received 5046 * @sta: currently connected station 5047 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame 5048 * 5049 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set, 5050 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame 5051 * from a connected station was received. 5052 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() 5053 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be 5054 * serialized. 5055 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown. 5056 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC 5057 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper 5058 * checks. 5059 */ 5060 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 5061 5062 /* 5063 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions. 5064 * This is enough for the radiotap header. 5065 */ 5066 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4) 5067 5068 /** 5069 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames 5070 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station 5071 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames 5072 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID 5073 * 5074 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing 5075 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need 5076 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit. 5077 * 5078 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are 5079 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data 5080 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim 5081 * call! Beware of the locking!) 5082 * 5083 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD) 5084 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are 5085 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes 5086 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data, 5087 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered 5088 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP). 5089 * 5090 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per 5091 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since 5092 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the 5093 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that 5094 * use this API. 5095 */ 5096 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5097 u8 tid, bool buffered); 5098 5099 /** 5100 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet 5101 * 5102 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support 5103 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent 5104 * rate selection table for the station entry. 5105 * 5106 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5107 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent. 5108 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. 5109 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information 5110 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch 5111 */ 5112 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5113 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5114 struct sk_buff *skb, 5115 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest, 5116 int max_rates); 5117 5118 /** 5119 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station 5120 * 5121 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput 5122 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can 5123 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station 5124 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic 5125 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause 5126 * slow stations to starve). 5127 * 5128 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for. 5129 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps. 5130 */ 5131 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 5132 u32 thr); 5133 5134 /** 5135 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback 5136 * 5137 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta 5138 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision 5139 * in updating the tx rate in data path. 5140 * 5141 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5142 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for. 5143 * @info: tx status information 5144 */ 5145 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5146 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 5147 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info); 5148 5149 /** 5150 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback 5151 * 5152 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been 5153 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for 5154 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics. 5155 * 5156 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 5157 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls 5158 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() 5159 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 5160 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni(). 5161 * 5162 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5163 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5164 */ 5165 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5166 struct sk_buff *skb); 5167 5168 /** 5169 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback 5170 * 5171 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status 5172 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not 5173 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info. 5174 * 5175 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized 5176 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() 5177 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5178 * 5179 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5180 * @status: tx status information 5181 */ 5182 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5183 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status); 5184 5185 /** 5186 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb 5187 * 5188 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status 5189 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to 5190 * specific skbs. 5191 * 5192 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized 5193 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() 5194 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5195 * 5196 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5197 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent 5198 * (NULL for multicast packets) 5199 * @info: tx status information 5200 */ 5201 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5202 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5203 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 5204 { 5205 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = { 5206 .sta = sta, 5207 .info = info, 5208 }; 5209 5210 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status); 5211 } 5212 5213 /** 5214 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context) 5215 * 5216 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context. 5217 * 5218 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and 5219 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed 5220 * for a single hardware. 5221 * 5222 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5223 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5224 */ 5225 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5226 struct sk_buff *skb) 5227 { 5228 local_bh_disable(); 5229 ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb); 5230 local_bh_enable(); 5231 } 5232 5233 /** 5234 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback 5235 * 5236 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context 5237 * (internally defers to a tasklet.) 5238 * 5239 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and 5240 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5241 * 5242 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5243 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5244 */ 5245 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5246 struct sk_buff *skb); 5247 5248 /** 5249 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station 5250 * 5251 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding 5252 * connected STA. 5253 * 5254 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta 5255 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response 5256 */ 5257 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets); 5258 5259 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2 5260 5261 /** 5262 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets 5263 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element 5264 * @tim_length: size of TIM element 5265 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets 5266 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which 5267 * should be ignored. 5268 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element 5269 */ 5270 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets { 5271 u16 tim_offset; 5272 u16 tim_length; 5273 5274 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM]; 5275 u16 mbssid_off; 5276 }; 5277 5278 /** 5279 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function 5280 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5281 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5282 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5283 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5284 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5285 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5286 * 5287 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to 5288 * obtain the beacon template. 5289 * 5290 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the 5291 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template 5292 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when 5293 * applicable, the CSA count. 5294 * 5295 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 5296 * 5297 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. 5298 */ 5299 struct sk_buff * 5300 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5301 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5302 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs, 5303 unsigned int link_id); 5304 5305 /** 5306 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation 5307 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5308 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5309 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5310 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5311 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP). 5312 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set. 5313 * 5314 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template() 5315 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the 5316 * requested index. 5317 * 5318 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates. 5319 */ 5320 struct sk_buff * 5321 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5322 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5323 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs, 5324 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index); 5325 5326 /** 5327 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons 5328 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons. 5329 * 5330 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons. 5331 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon 5332 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5333 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5334 */ 5335 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons { 5336 u8 cnt; 5337 struct { 5338 struct sk_buff *skb; 5339 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs; 5340 } bcn[]; 5341 }; 5342 5343 /** 5344 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation 5345 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5346 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5347 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP) 5348 * 5349 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template() 5350 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required 5351 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only 5352 * one multiple BSSID element. 5353 * 5354 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory. 5355 * 5356 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *. 5357 * %NULL on error. 5358 */ 5359 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons * 5360 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5361 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5362 unsigned int link_id); 5363 5364 /** 5365 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list 5366 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers. 5367 * 5368 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling 5369 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list() 5370 */ 5371 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons); 5372 5373 /** 5374 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function 5375 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5376 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5377 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset. 5378 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). 5379 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length, 5380 * (including the ID and length bytes!). 5381 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). 5382 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5383 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5384 * 5385 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to 5386 * obtain the beacon frame. 5387 * 5388 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5389 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon 5390 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly 5391 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt). 5392 * 5393 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 5394 * 5395 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. 5396 */ 5397 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5398 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5399 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length, 5400 unsigned int link_id); 5401 5402 /** 5403 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function 5404 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5405 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5406 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5407 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5408 * 5409 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). 5410 * 5411 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). 5412 */ 5413 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5414 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5415 unsigned int link_id) 5416 { 5417 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id); 5418 } 5419 5420 /** 5421 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown 5422 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5423 * 5424 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission. 5425 * This function is called implicitly when 5426 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the 5427 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this 5428 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown. 5429 * 5430 * Return: new countdown value 5431 */ 5432 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5433 5434 /** 5435 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown 5436 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5437 * @counter: the new value for the counter 5438 * 5439 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be 5440 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211. 5441 * 5442 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(), 5443 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value. 5444 */ 5445 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter); 5446 5447 /** 5448 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch 5449 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5450 * 5451 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this 5452 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to 5453 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed. 5454 */ 5455 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5456 5457 /** 5458 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1 5459 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5460 * 5461 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero. 5462 */ 5463 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5464 5465 /** 5466 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change 5467 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5468 * 5469 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this 5470 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to 5471 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed 5472 */ 5473 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5474 5475 /** 5476 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template 5477 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5478 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5479 * 5480 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to 5481 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller. 5482 * 5483 * Can only be called in AP mode. 5484 * 5485 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error. 5486 */ 5487 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5488 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5489 5490 /** 5491 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template 5492 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5493 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5494 * 5495 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to 5496 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct 5497 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used. 5498 * 5499 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the 5500 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit. 5501 * 5502 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error. 5503 */ 5504 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5505 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5506 5507 /** 5508 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template 5509 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5510 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5511 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses 5512 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with 5513 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be. 5514 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set 5515 * if at all possible 5516 * 5517 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to 5518 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct 5519 * BSSID and address is used. 5520 * 5521 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the 5522 * returned packet will be QoS NDP. 5523 * 5524 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the 5525 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields. 5526 * 5527 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error. 5528 */ 5529 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5530 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5531 int link_id, bool qos_ok); 5532 5533 /** 5534 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template 5535 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5536 * @src_addr: source MAC address 5537 * @ssid: SSID buffer 5538 * @ssid_len: length of SSID 5539 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs 5540 * 5541 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to 5542 * hardware. 5543 * 5544 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. 5545 */ 5546 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5547 const u8 *src_addr, 5548 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 5549 size_t tailroom); 5550 5551 /** 5552 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function 5553 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5554 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5555 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. 5556 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). 5557 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5558 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame. 5559 * 5560 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5561 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5562 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible 5563 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed. 5564 */ 5565 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5566 const void *frame, size_t frame_len, 5567 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, 5568 struct ieee80211_rts *rts); 5569 5570 /** 5571 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame 5572 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5573 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5574 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. 5575 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5576 * 5577 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide 5578 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5579 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. 5580 * 5581 * Return: The duration. 5582 */ 5583 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5584 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len, 5585 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); 5586 5587 /** 5588 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function 5589 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5590 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5591 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. 5592 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). 5593 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5594 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame. 5595 * 5596 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5597 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5598 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible 5599 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed. 5600 */ 5601 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5602 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5603 const void *frame, size_t frame_len, 5604 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, 5605 struct ieee80211_cts *cts); 5606 5607 /** 5608 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame 5609 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5610 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5611 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. 5612 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5613 * 5614 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide 5615 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5616 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. 5617 * 5618 * Return: The duration. 5619 */ 5620 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5621 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5622 size_t frame_len, 5623 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); 5624 5625 /** 5626 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame 5627 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5628 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5629 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on 5630 * @frame_len: the length of the frame. 5631 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted. 5632 * 5633 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its 5634 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps). 5635 * 5636 * Return: The duration. 5637 */ 5638 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5639 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5640 enum nl80211_band band, 5641 size_t frame_len, 5642 struct ieee80211_rate *rate); 5643 5644 /** 5645 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames 5646 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5647 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5648 * 5649 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If 5650 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast 5651 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host 5652 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered 5653 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame. 5654 * 5655 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered 5656 * frames are available. 5657 * 5658 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was 5659 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus 5660 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns 5661 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver 5662 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to 5663 * use common code for all beacons. 5664 */ 5665 struct sk_buff * 5666 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5667 5668 /** 5669 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32 5670 * 5671 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32. 5672 * 5673 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5674 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for 5675 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5676 */ 5677 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5678 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); 5679 5680 /** 5681 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key 5682 * 5683 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken 5684 * from the given packet. 5685 * 5686 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5687 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted 5688 * with this P1K 5689 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5690 */ 5691 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5692 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k) 5693 { 5694 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data; 5695 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control); 5696 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]); 5697 5698 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k); 5699 } 5700 5701 /** 5702 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX 5703 * 5704 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32 5705 * and transmitter address. 5706 * 5707 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5708 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key 5709 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for 5710 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5711 */ 5712 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5713 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); 5714 5715 /** 5716 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key 5717 * 5718 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values 5719 * in the packet. 5720 * 5721 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5722 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be 5723 * encrypted with this key 5724 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes 5725 */ 5726 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5727 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k); 5728 5729 /** 5730 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos 5731 * 5732 * @pos: start of crypto header 5733 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5734 * @pn: PN to add 5735 * 5736 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of 5737 * the packet payload) 5738 * 5739 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should 5740 * point to the crypto header) 5741 */ 5742 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn); 5743 5744 /** 5745 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter 5746 * 5747 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5748 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only); 5749 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For 5750 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. 5751 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data 5752 * 5753 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs 5754 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done 5755 * by the device and not by mac80211. 5756 * 5757 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing 5758 * can be done concurrently. 5759 */ 5760 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5761 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 5762 5763 /** 5764 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter 5765 * 5766 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5767 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only); 5768 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For 5769 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. 5770 * @seq: new sequence data 5771 * 5772 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the 5773 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK 5774 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called 5775 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211. 5776 * 5777 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing 5778 * can be done concurrently. 5779 */ 5780 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5781 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 5782 5783 /** 5784 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key 5785 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5786 * 5787 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the 5788 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but 5789 * instead assumed to have been removed already. 5790 * 5791 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently) 5792 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().) 5793 */ 5794 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5795 5796 /** 5797 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN 5798 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on 5799 * @keyconf: new key data 5800 * 5801 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new 5802 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper 5803 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them. 5804 * 5805 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will 5806 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to 5807 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an 5808 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc. 5809 * 5810 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware 5811 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK 5812 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver 5813 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses 5814 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part 5815 * of the reconfiguration. 5816 * 5817 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq() 5818 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly. 5819 * 5820 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware, 5821 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases 5822 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for 5823 * the key that's being replaced. 5824 */ 5825 struct ieee80211_key_conf * 5826 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5827 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5828 5829 /** 5830 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying 5831 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on 5832 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association 5833 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying 5834 * @gfp: allocation flags 5835 */ 5836 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid, 5837 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 5838 5839 /** 5840 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key 5841 * 5842 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called 5843 * at the same time. 5844 * 5845 * @keyconf: the key in question 5846 */ 5847 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5848 5849 /** 5850 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key 5851 * 5852 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called 5853 * at the same time. 5854 * 5855 * @keyconf: the key in question 5856 */ 5857 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5858 5859 /** 5860 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue 5861 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5862 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5863 * 5864 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue. 5865 */ 5866 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5867 5868 /** 5869 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue 5870 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5871 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5872 * 5873 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue. 5874 */ 5875 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5876 5877 /** 5878 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue 5879 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5880 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5881 * 5882 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped. 5883 * 5884 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise. 5885 */ 5886 5887 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5888 5889 /** 5890 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues 5891 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5892 * 5893 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues. 5894 */ 5895 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5896 5897 /** 5898 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues 5899 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5900 * 5901 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues. 5902 */ 5903 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5904 5905 /** 5906 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan 5907 * 5908 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is 5909 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify 5910 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from 5911 * any context, including hardirq context. 5912 * 5913 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan 5914 * @info: information about the completed scan 5915 */ 5916 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5917 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 5918 5919 /** 5920 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan 5921 * 5922 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the 5923 * driver whenever there are new scan results available. 5924 * 5925 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans 5926 */ 5927 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5928 5929 /** 5930 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped 5931 * 5932 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by 5933 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task. 5934 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan 5935 * while associating, for instance. 5936 * 5937 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans 5938 */ 5939 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5940 5941 /** 5942 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags 5943 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have 5944 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware 5945 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new 5946 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they 5947 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet. 5948 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all 5949 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet. 5950 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up). 5951 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA 5952 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery 5953 * for instance. 5954 */ 5955 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags { 5956 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0, 5957 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0), 5958 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1), 5959 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2), 5960 }; 5961 5962 /** 5963 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces 5964 * 5965 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 5966 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as 5967 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep. 5968 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 5969 * 5970 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 5971 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 5972 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 5973 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 5974 */ 5975 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags, 5976 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, 5977 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 5978 void *data); 5979 5980 /** 5981 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces 5982 * 5983 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 5984 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 5985 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator 5986 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can 5987 * be used. 5988 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 5989 * 5990 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 5991 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 5992 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 5993 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 5994 */ 5995 static inline void 5996 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags, 5997 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, 5998 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 5999 void *data) 6000 { 6001 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, 6002 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE, 6003 iterator, data); 6004 } 6005 6006 /** 6007 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces 6008 * 6009 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6010 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 6011 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, 6012 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead. 6013 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 6014 * 6015 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6016 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6017 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6018 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6019 */ 6020 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6021 u32 iter_flags, 6022 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6023 u8 *mac, 6024 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6025 void *data); 6026 6027 /** 6028 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces 6029 * 6030 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6031 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 6032 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex. 6033 * 6034 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6035 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6036 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6037 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6038 */ 6039 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6040 u32 iter_flags, 6041 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6042 u8 *mac, 6043 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6044 void *data); 6045 6046 /** 6047 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations 6048 * 6049 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given 6050 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback 6051 * function for them. 6052 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, 6053 * 6054 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6055 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6056 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6057 */ 6058 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6059 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6060 struct ieee80211_sta *sta), 6061 void *data); 6062 /** 6063 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue 6064 * 6065 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue. 6066 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be. 6067 * 6068 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for 6069 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue 6070 */ 6071 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work); 6072 6073 /** 6074 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue 6075 * 6076 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211 6077 * workqueue. 6078 * 6079 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for 6080 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue 6081 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing 6082 */ 6083 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6084 struct delayed_work *dwork, 6085 unsigned long delay); 6086 6087 /** 6088 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer. 6089 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session 6090 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6091 * 6092 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer 6093 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the 6094 * mac80211. 6095 * 6096 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section. 6097 */ 6098 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6099 u16 tid); 6100 6101 /** 6102 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session. 6103 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session 6104 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6105 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs) 6106 * 6107 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise 6108 * 6109 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate 6110 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level 6111 * will be managed by the mac80211. 6112 */ 6113 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid, 6114 u16 timeout); 6115 6116 /** 6117 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate. 6118 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6119 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. 6120 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6121 * 6122 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has 6123 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called 6124 * from any context. 6125 */ 6126 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, 6127 u16 tid); 6128 6129 /** 6130 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session. 6131 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop 6132 * @tid: the TID to stop BA. 6133 * 6134 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active 6135 * 6136 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate 6137 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level 6138 * will be managed by the mac80211. 6139 */ 6140 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid); 6141 6142 /** 6143 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate. 6144 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6145 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. 6146 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on. 6147 * 6148 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has 6149 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It 6150 * can be called from any context. 6151 */ 6152 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, 6153 u16 tid); 6154 6155 /** 6156 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station 6157 * 6158 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on 6159 * @addr: station's address 6160 * 6161 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. 6162 * 6163 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the 6164 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. 6165 */ 6166 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6167 const u8 *addr); 6168 6169 /** 6170 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware 6171 * 6172 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6173 * @addr: remote station's address 6174 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'. 6175 * 6176 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. 6177 * 6178 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the 6179 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. 6180 * 6181 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get 6182 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'. 6183 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple 6184 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another 6185 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first). 6186 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL 6187 * is not reliable. 6188 * 6189 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible. 6190 */ 6191 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6192 const u8 *addr, 6193 const u8 *localaddr); 6194 6195 /** 6196 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses 6197 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6198 * @addr: remote station's link address 6199 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that) 6200 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found, 6201 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed 6202 * 6203 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection. 6204 */ 6205 struct ieee80211_sta * 6206 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6207 const u8 *addr, 6208 const u8 *localaddr, 6209 unsigned int *link_id); 6210 6211 /** 6212 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up 6213 * @hw: the hardware 6214 * @pubsta: the station 6215 * @block: whether to block or unblock 6216 * 6217 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues 6218 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before 6219 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be 6220 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected 6221 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag. 6222 * 6223 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free 6224 * manner. 6225 * 6226 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames 6227 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not 6228 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call 6229 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to 6230 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the 6231 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must 6232 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will 6233 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if 6234 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also 6235 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver 6236 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after 6237 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually 6238 * woke up while blocked or not. 6239 */ 6240 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6241 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block); 6242 6243 /** 6244 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP 6245 * @pubsta: the station 6246 * 6247 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell 6248 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the 6249 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead. 6250 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD. 6251 * 6252 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must 6253 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function 6254 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or 6255 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix! 6256 * 6257 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no 6258 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if 6259 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history 6260 * and restore the _irqsafe version! 6261 */ 6262 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 6263 6264 /** 6265 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP 6266 * @pubsta: the station 6267 * @tid: the tid of the NDP 6268 * 6269 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close 6270 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when 6271 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window. 6272 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a 6273 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the 6274 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to 6275 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any 6276 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong. 6277 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame 6278 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save. 6279 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames(). 6280 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver 6281 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call 6282 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent. 6283 */ 6284 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid); 6285 6286 /** 6287 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change 6288 * @pubsta: the station 6289 * 6290 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in 6291 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of 6292 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta. 6293 * 6294 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case 6295 * there is no need to call this function. 6296 */ 6297 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 6298 6299 /** 6300 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid 6301 * 6302 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call 6303 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of 6304 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule 6305 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness. 6306 * 6307 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent 6308 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not 6309 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the 6310 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame 6311 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission 6312 * attempts. 6313 * 6314 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or 6315 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available. 6316 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of 6317 * them to 0. 6318 * 6319 * @pubsta: the station 6320 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for 6321 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec) 6322 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec) 6323 */ 6324 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid, 6325 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime); 6326 6327 /** 6328 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device 6329 * 6330 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6331 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 6332 * 6333 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can 6334 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false. 6335 */ 6336 bool 6337 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 6338 6339 /** 6340 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device 6341 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6342 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all 6343 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key 6344 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function 6345 * 6346 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to 6347 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into 6348 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device 6349 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due 6350 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few 6351 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep. 6352 * 6353 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order 6354 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the 6355 * set_key callback. 6356 */ 6357 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6358 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6359 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6360 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6361 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6362 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 6363 void *data), 6364 void *iter_data); 6365 6366 /** 6367 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device 6368 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6369 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all 6370 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key 6371 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function 6372 * 6373 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to 6374 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into 6375 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station 6376 * in removal process will be skipped. 6377 * 6378 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section, 6379 * and thus iter must be atomic. 6380 */ 6381 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6382 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6383 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6384 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6385 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6386 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 6387 void *data), 6388 void *iter_data); 6389 6390 /** 6391 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts 6392 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 6393 * @iter: iterator function 6394 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function 6395 * 6396 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and 6397 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other 6398 * places while calling into the driver. 6399 * 6400 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during 6401 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being 6402 * removed. 6403 * 6404 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed 6405 * before the restart are considered already present so will be 6406 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already 6407 * or not. 6408 */ 6409 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic( 6410 struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6411 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6412 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf, 6413 void *data), 6414 void *iter_data); 6415 6416 /** 6417 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template 6418 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 6419 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6420 * 6421 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to 6422 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate 6423 * information. This function must only be called from within the 6424 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function 6425 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return 6426 * %NULL. 6427 * 6428 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. 6429 */ 6430 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6431 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6432 6433 /** 6434 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons 6435 * 6436 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6437 * 6438 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and 6439 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the 6440 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function. 6441 */ 6442 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6443 6444 /** 6445 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP 6446 * 6447 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6448 * 6449 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and 6450 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver 6451 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost. 6452 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated 6453 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set. 6454 * 6455 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state, 6456 * without connection recovery attempts. 6457 */ 6458 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6459 6460 /** 6461 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection 6462 * 6463 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6464 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired 6465 * 6466 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a 6467 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired. 6468 */ 6469 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect); 6470 6471 /** 6472 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume 6473 * 6474 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6475 * 6476 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume. 6477 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the 6478 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were 6479 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or 6480 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume. 6481 * 6482 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses 6483 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface 6484 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then 6485 * disconnect normally later. 6486 * 6487 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and 6488 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it 6489 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the 6490 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto). 6491 */ 6492 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6493 6494 /** 6495 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after 6496 * hardware restart 6497 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6498 * 6499 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after 6500 * hardware restart. 6501 */ 6502 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6503 6504 /** 6505 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring 6506 * rssi threshold triggered 6507 * 6508 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6509 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type 6510 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 6511 * @gfp: context flags 6512 * 6513 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality 6514 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform 6515 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold. 6516 */ 6517 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6518 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 6519 s32 rssi_level, 6520 gfp_t gfp); 6521 6522 /** 6523 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss 6524 * 6525 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6526 * @gfp: context flags 6527 */ 6528 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp); 6529 6530 /** 6531 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected 6532 * 6533 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6534 */ 6535 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6536 6537 /** 6538 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process 6539 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6540 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not 6541 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is 6542 * false. 6543 * 6544 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel 6545 * and wake up the suspended queues. 6546 */ 6547 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success, 6548 unsigned int link_id); 6549 6550 /** 6551 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error 6552 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6553 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame. 6554 * 6555 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel 6556 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send 6557 * a deauth frame in this case. 6558 */ 6559 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6560 bool block_tx); 6561 6562 /** 6563 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition 6564 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6565 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0 6566 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode 6567 * 6568 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed 6569 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than 6570 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth. 6571 */ 6572 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id, 6573 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode); 6574 6575 /** 6576 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start 6577 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6578 */ 6579 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6580 6581 /** 6582 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 6583 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6584 */ 6585 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6586 6587 /** 6588 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions 6589 * 6590 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device 6591 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba 6592 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs 6593 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)." 6594 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and 6595 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation. 6596 * 6597 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6598 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid 6599 * @addr: & to bssid mac address 6600 */ 6601 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap, 6602 const u8 *addr); 6603 6604 /** 6605 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered 6606 * @pubsta: station struct 6607 * @tid: the session's TID 6608 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are 6609 * assumed to be out of the window after the call 6610 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc. 6611 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware 6612 * 6613 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and 6614 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it 6615 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released 6616 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.) 6617 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames) 6618 */ 6619 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid, 6620 u16 ssn, u64 filtered, 6621 u16 received_mpdus); 6622 6623 /** 6624 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame 6625 * 6626 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder 6627 * buffer. 6628 * 6629 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6630 * @ra: the peer's destination address 6631 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session 6632 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver 6633 */ 6634 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn); 6635 6636 /** 6637 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work 6638 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6639 * @addr: station mac address 6640 * @tid: the rx tid 6641 */ 6642 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr, 6643 unsigned int tid); 6644 6645 /** 6646 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session 6647 * 6648 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including 6649 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx 6650 * reordering. 6651 * 6652 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here 6653 * when they complete AddBa negotiation. 6654 * 6655 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6656 * @addr: station mac address 6657 * @tid: the rx tid 6658 */ 6659 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6660 const u8 *addr, u16 tid) 6661 { 6662 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)) 6663 return; 6664 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid); 6665 } 6666 6667 /** 6668 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session 6669 * 6670 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including 6671 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx 6672 * reordering. 6673 * 6674 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here 6675 * when they complete DelBa negotiation. 6676 * 6677 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6678 * @addr: station mac address 6679 * @tid: the rx tid 6680 */ 6681 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6682 const u8 *addr, u16 tid) 6683 { 6684 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)) 6685 return; 6686 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS); 6687 } 6688 6689 /** 6690 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout 6691 * 6692 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx 6693 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer. 6694 * 6695 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa. 6696 * 6697 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6698 * @addr: station mac address 6699 * @tid: the rx tid 6700 */ 6701 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6702 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid); 6703 6704 /* Rate control API */ 6705 6706 /** 6707 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo 6708 * 6709 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for. 6710 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on. 6711 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration 6712 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs 6713 * to be filled in 6714 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate 6715 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and 6716 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network. 6717 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the 6718 * RTS threshold 6719 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission 6720 * if the selected rate supports it 6721 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask 6722 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use) 6723 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode 6724 */ 6725 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control { 6726 struct ieee80211_hw *hw; 6727 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband; 6728 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf; 6729 struct sk_buff *skb; 6730 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate; 6731 bool rts, short_preamble; 6732 u32 rate_idx_mask; 6733 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask; 6734 bool bss; 6735 }; 6736 6737 /** 6738 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities 6739 */ 6740 enum rate_control_capabilities { 6741 /** 6742 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: 6743 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable) 6744 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains 6745 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has, 6746 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us. 6747 */ 6748 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0), 6749 /** 6750 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER: 6751 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx 6752 */ 6753 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1), 6754 }; 6755 6756 struct rate_control_ops { 6757 unsigned long capa; 6758 const char *name; 6759 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6760 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv, 6761 struct dentry *debugfsdir); 6762 void (*free)(void *priv); 6763 6764 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp); 6765 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6766 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6767 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta); 6768 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6769 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6770 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6771 u32 changed); 6772 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6773 void *priv_sta); 6774 6775 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv, 6776 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6777 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st); 6778 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6779 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6780 struct sk_buff *skb); 6781 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6782 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc); 6783 6784 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta, 6785 struct dentry *dir); 6786 6787 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta); 6788 }; 6789 6790 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6791 enum nl80211_band band, 6792 int index) 6793 { 6794 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index)); 6795 } 6796 6797 static inline s8 6798 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6799 struct ieee80211_sta *sta) 6800 { 6801 int i; 6802 6803 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) 6804 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) 6805 return i; 6806 6807 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */ 6808 WARN_ON_ONCE(1); 6809 6810 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */ 6811 return 0; 6812 } 6813 6814 static inline 6815 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6816 struct ieee80211_sta *sta) 6817 { 6818 unsigned int i; 6819 6820 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) 6821 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) 6822 return true; 6823 return false; 6824 } 6825 6826 /** 6827 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver 6828 * 6829 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass 6830 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station 6831 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on 6832 * the most recent rate control module decision. 6833 * 6834 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6835 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination. 6836 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station. 6837 */ 6838 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6839 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 6840 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates); 6841 6842 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); 6843 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); 6844 6845 static inline bool 6846 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6847 { 6848 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20; 6849 } 6850 6851 static inline bool 6852 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6853 { 6854 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && 6855 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; 6856 } 6857 6858 static inline bool 6859 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6860 { 6861 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && 6862 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; 6863 } 6864 6865 static inline bool 6866 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6867 { 6868 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40; 6869 } 6870 6871 static inline bool 6872 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6873 { 6874 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) && 6875 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) && 6876 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT); 6877 } 6878 6879 static inline enum nl80211_iftype 6880 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p) 6881 { 6882 if (p2p) { 6883 switch (type) { 6884 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: 6885 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT; 6886 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: 6887 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO; 6888 default: 6889 break; 6890 } 6891 } 6892 return type; 6893 } 6894 6895 static inline enum nl80211_iftype 6896 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6897 { 6898 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p); 6899 } 6900 6901 /** 6902 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif 6903 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 6904 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6905 * 6906 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found 6907 */ 6908 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 6909 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6910 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6911 { 6912 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6913 } 6914 6915 /** 6916 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 6917 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 6918 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6919 * 6920 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 6921 */ 6922 static inline __le16 6923 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6924 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6925 { 6926 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6927 } 6928 6929 /** 6930 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif 6931 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 6932 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6933 * 6934 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found 6935 */ 6936 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap * 6937 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6938 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6939 { 6940 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6941 } 6942 6943 /** 6944 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data 6945 * 6946 * @vif: the specified virtual interface 6947 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0 6948 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group 6949 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group 6950 * 6951 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and 6952 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the 6953 * matching GroupId management frame. 6954 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path. 6955 */ 6956 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id, 6957 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position); 6958 6959 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6960 int rssi_min_thold, 6961 int rssi_max_thold); 6962 6963 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6964 6965 /** 6966 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface 6967 * 6968 * @vif: the specified virtual interface 6969 * 6970 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid. 6971 * 6972 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not 6973 * applicable. 6974 */ 6975 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6976 6977 /** 6978 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup 6979 * @vif: virtual interface 6980 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s) 6981 * @gfp: allocation flags 6982 * 6983 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(). 6984 */ 6985 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6986 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 6987 gfp_t gfp); 6988 6989 /** 6990 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission 6991 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6992 * @vif: virtual interface 6993 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver 6994 * @band: the band to transmit on 6995 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to 6996 * 6997 * Note: must be called under RCU lock 6998 */ 6999 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7000 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb, 7001 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta); 7002 7003 /** 7004 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header 7005 * of injected frames. 7006 * 7007 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields, 7008 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure 7009 * of the skb before calling this function. 7010 * 7011 * @skb: packet injected by userspace 7012 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device 7013 */ 7014 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb, 7015 struct net_device *dev); 7016 7017 /** 7018 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state 7019 * 7020 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change 7021 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending 7022 * 7023 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent 7024 * 7025 * private: 7026 * 7027 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors 7028 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA 7029 */ 7030 struct ieee80211_noa_data { 7031 u32 next_tsf; 7032 bool has_next_tsf; 7033 7034 u8 absent; 7035 7036 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; 7037 struct { 7038 u32 start; 7039 u32 duration; 7040 u32 interval; 7041 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; 7042 }; 7043 7044 /** 7045 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE 7046 * 7047 * @attr: P2P NoA IE 7048 * @data: NoA tracking data 7049 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp 7050 * 7051 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors 7052 */ 7053 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr, 7054 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); 7055 7056 /** 7057 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change 7058 * 7059 * @data: NoA tracking data 7060 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp 7061 */ 7062 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); 7063 7064 /** 7065 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation 7066 * @vif: virtual interface 7067 * @peer: the peer's destination address 7068 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation 7069 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown 7070 * @gfp: allocation flags 7071 * 7072 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(). 7073 */ 7074 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer, 7075 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 7076 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 7077 7078 /** 7079 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID 7080 * 7081 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from 7082 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such 7083 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID, 7084 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks 7085 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be 7086 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC. 7087 * 7088 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it 7089 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should 7090 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback. 7091 * 7092 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for 7093 * @tid: the TID to reserve 7094 * 7095 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure 7096 */ 7097 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 7098 7099 /** 7100 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID 7101 * 7102 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function 7103 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for 7104 * preventing use of this TID in the driver. 7105 * 7106 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called 7107 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called 7108 * from the driver's @sta_state callback. 7109 * 7110 * @sta: the station 7111 * @tid: the TID to unreserve 7112 */ 7113 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 7114 7115 /** 7116 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue 7117 * 7118 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7119 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from 7120 * ieee80211_next_txq() 7121 * 7122 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available. 7123 * 7124 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section, 7125 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in 7126 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the 7127 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call 7128 * but for the duration of the frame handling. 7129 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method, 7130 * rcu_read_lock() is already held. 7131 * 7132 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called. 7133 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead. 7134 */ 7135 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7136 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7137 7138 /** 7139 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue 7140 * (in process context) 7141 * 7142 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context 7143 * (internally disables bottom halves). 7144 * 7145 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7146 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from 7147 * ieee80211_next_txq() 7148 */ 7149 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7150 struct ieee80211_txq *txq) 7151 { 7152 struct sk_buff *skb; 7153 7154 local_bh_disable(); 7155 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq); 7156 local_bh_enable(); 7157 7158 return skb; 7159 } 7160 7161 /** 7162 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback 7163 * 7164 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback(). 7165 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback(). 7166 * 7167 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue 7168 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function. 7169 */ 7170 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7171 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7172 7173 /** 7174 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from 7175 * 7176 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7177 * @ac: AC number to return packets from. 7178 * 7179 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq 7180 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the 7181 * driver has finished scheduling it. 7182 */ 7183 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac); 7184 7185 /** 7186 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs 7187 * 7188 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7189 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for 7190 * 7191 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq(). 7192 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently. 7193 */ 7194 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac); 7195 7196 /* (deprecated) */ 7197 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac) 7198 { 7199 } 7200 7201 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7202 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force); 7203 7204 /** 7205 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission 7206 * 7207 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7208 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7209 * 7210 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled, 7211 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered. 7212 * 7213 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for 7214 * this TXQ internally. 7215 */ 7216 static inline void 7217 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq) 7218 { 7219 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true); 7220 } 7221 7222 /** 7223 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq() 7224 * 7225 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7226 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7227 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets. 7228 * 7229 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ 7230 * internally. 7231 */ 7232 static inline void 7233 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq, 7234 bool force) 7235 { 7236 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force); 7237 } 7238 7239 /** 7240 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit 7241 * 7242 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by 7243 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime 7244 * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by 7245 * next_txq(). 7246 * 7247 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to 7248 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have 7249 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will 7250 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit 7251 * again. 7252 * 7253 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be 7254 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates 7255 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry 7256 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this 7257 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets 7258 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq(). 7259 * 7260 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7261 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7262 */ 7263 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7264 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7265 7266 /** 7267 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq 7268 * 7269 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e. 7270 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up 7271 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa. 7272 * 7273 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7274 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count 7275 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count 7276 */ 7277 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq, 7278 unsigned long *frame_cnt, 7279 unsigned long *byte_cnt); 7280 7281 /** 7282 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 7283 * 7284 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination. 7285 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq. 7286 * 7287 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7288 * @inst_id: the local instance id 7289 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 7290 * @gfp: allocation flags 7291 */ 7292 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7293 u8 inst_id, 7294 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 7295 gfp_t gfp); 7296 7297 /** 7298 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event. 7299 * 7300 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The 7301 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211. 7302 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq. 7303 * 7304 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7305 * @match: match event information 7306 * @gfp: allocation flags 7307 */ 7308 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7309 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, 7310 gfp_t gfp); 7311 7312 /** 7313 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX. 7314 * 7315 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the 7316 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length. 7317 * 7318 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7319 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate 7320 * information. 7321 * @len: frame length in bytes 7322 */ 7323 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7324 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status, 7325 int len); 7326 7327 /** 7328 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX. 7329 * 7330 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the 7331 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length. 7332 * 7333 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7334 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 7335 * @len: frame length in bytes 7336 */ 7337 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7338 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, 7339 int len); 7340 /** 7341 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading. 7342 * 7343 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3 7344 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the 7345 * hardware or firmware. 7346 * 7347 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7348 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off 7349 */ 7350 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable); 7351 7352 /** 7353 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template. 7354 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 7355 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7356 * 7357 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 7358 * 7359 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error. 7360 */ 7361 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7362 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7363 7364 /** 7365 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast 7366 * probe response template. 7367 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 7368 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7369 * 7370 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 7371 * 7372 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error. 7373 */ 7374 struct sk_buff * 7375 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7376 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7377 7378 /** 7379 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color 7380 * collision. 7381 * 7382 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7383 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is 7384 * aware of. 7385 * @gfp: allocation flags 7386 */ 7387 void 7388 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7389 u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp); 7390 7391 /** 7392 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame 7393 * 7394 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with 7395 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames. 7396 * 7397 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. 7398 */ 7399 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb) 7400 { 7401 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb); 7402 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data; 7403 7404 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP || 7405 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control); 7406 } 7407 7408 /** 7409 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode 7410 * @vif: interface to set active links on 7411 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap 7412 * 7413 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface 7414 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active), 7415 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links. 7416 * 7417 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same 7418 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get 7419 * a sequence of calls like 7420 * - change_vif_links(0x11) 7421 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0) 7422 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP) 7423 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down) 7424 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0) 7425 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4) 7426 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP) 7427 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4) 7428 * - change_vif_links(0x10) 7429 * 7430 * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not 7431 * be called with any driver locks held that could cause a 7432 * lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks. 7433 */ 7434 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links); 7435 7436 /** 7437 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links 7438 * @vif: interface to set active links on 7439 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap 7440 * 7441 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only 7442 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and 7443 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be 7444 * completed after it returns. 7445 */ 7446 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7447 u16 active_links); 7448 7449 #endif /* MAC80211_H */ 7450